Escolar Documentos
Profissional Documentos
Cultura Documentos
Command Reference
Release 2.0
THE PRODUCT INFORMATION PRESENTED WITHIN THIS DOCUMENT IS SUBJECT TO CHANGE WITHOUT NOTICE. ALL PRODUCT INFORMATION IS BELIEVED TO BE ACCURATE, BUT IS PROVIDED WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED. NETSOCKET, INC. ACCEPTS NO RESPONSIBILITY FOR USERS SPECIFIC APPLICATION OF THE PRODUCT(S) FEATURED WITHIN THIS DOCUMENT. NEITHER NETSOCKET, INC. NOR ITS SUPPLIERS SHALL BE LIABLE FOR DAM AGES OF ANY KIND, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, LOSS OF DATA OR REVENUE, ARISING FROM THE USE OF THE FEATURED PRODUCT(S) AND ASSOCIATED INFORMATION PRESENTED WITHIN THIS DOCUMENT.
NETSOCKET INC., CONFIDENTIAL THE INFORMATION CONTAINED IN THIS DOCUMENT IS THE PROPERTY OF NETSOCKET. EXCEPT AS SPECIFICALLY AUTHORIZED IN WRITING BY NETSOCKET, THE HOLDER OF THIS DOCUMENT SHALL KEEP THE INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN CONFIDENTIAL AND SHALL PROTECT SAME IN WHOLE OR IN PART FROM DISCLOS URE AND DISSEMINATION TO THIRD PARTIES AND USE SAME FOR EVALUATION, OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE PURPOSES ONLY. THE CONTENT OF THIS DOCUMENT IS PROVIDED FOR INFORMATION PURPOSES ONLY AND IS SUBJECT TO MODIFICATION. IT DOES NOT CONSTITUTE ANY REPRESENTATION OR WARRANTY FROM NETSOCKET AS TO THE CONTENT OR ACCURACY OF THE INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE SUITABILITY AND PERFORMANCES OF THE PRODUCT OR ITS INTENDED APPLICATION.
Table of Contents
1 Introduction ................................................................................................................................ 1-1 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 2 About the Document ........................................................................................................ 1-1 Audience .......................................................................................................................... 1-1 How to Get Help .............................................................................................................. 1-1 Product Documentation ................................................................................................... 1-1
System Overview ...................................................................................................................... 2-2 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 ICE Correlation ................................................................................................................ 2-2 SVM ................................................................................................................................. 2-3 SVP .................................................................................................................................. 2-3 SVA .................................................................................................................................. 2-4 2.4.1 2.4.2 2.5 2.6 SVA Standard IP MOS Monitoring ...................................................................... 2-4 SVAA IP MOS Plus Analogue ............................................................................. 2-4
SVM Dashboard .............................................................................................................. 2-4 Calls, Sessions, and Media ............................................................................................. 2-5
Initial System Access ................................................................................................................ 3-1 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 1U Server......................................................................................................................... 3-1 2U Server......................................................................................................................... 3-2 CLI Access using the Default IP Address ........................................................................ 3-2 CLI Access using the Serial Ports ................................................................................... 3-3 3.4.1 3.4.2 3.5 System Serial Ports ............................................................................................. 3-3 Accessing the CLI from a Serial Port .................................................................. 3-4
CLI Basics ................................................................................................................................. 4-1 4.1 Command Structure ........................................................................................................ 4-1 4.1.1 4.1.2 4.1.3 4.2 4.2.1 4.2.2 Command Classes .............................................................................................. 4-1 Command Modes ................................................................................................ 4-1 Command Syntax ................................................................................................ 4-3 CLI Functions ...................................................................................................... 4-4 CLI Customization ............................................................................................... 4-7
Introduction
The NetSocket solution consists of the Service Visibility Manager (SVM), the Service Visibility Point (SVP), and the Service Visibility Analyzer (SVA). This document provides basic description of the SVM, SVP, and SVA, as well as a web-based Graphical User Interface (GUI) called the SVM Dashboard.
1.1
1.2
Audience
The Command and Configuration Guide is intended for the individuals tasked with the turn-up and configuration of the SVM, SVP, and SVA in the providers network.
1.3
1.4
Product Documentation
Following is the list of all documents included into the product documentation suite: Software Release Notes Installation Guide contains installation procedures. User Guide contains description and explanation of the SVM, SVP, and SVA functionality. The User Guide is intended for SVM Dashboard users. Command and Configuration Guide contains CLI command definitions and configuration examples. SVM SNMP Reference contains information about NetSockets proprietary MIBs and SNMP Traps.
1-1
Introduction
System Overview
The NetSocket Cloud Experience Manager (CEM) provides real-time IP service assurance for Unified Communications environments correlating real-time session (signaling), media (voice/video) streams and topology paths and events for Unified Communications applications. The solution consists of three component types: The Service Visibility Manager (SVM) is an element management system for the SVPs and SVAs. The SVM provides a web based GUI, called the SVM Dashboard, used to monitor the NetSocket CEM. The Service Visibility Point (SVP) is a server appliance that monitors the layer-3 IP network and the layer-4 session signaling. The Service Visibility Analyzer (SVA) is a server appliance that monitors and analyzes Quality of Experience (QoE) for media streams associated with the sessions monitored by the SVP. The NetSocket CEM works in a hierarchical model where one SVM monitors one or more SVPs and an SVP can monitor zero or more SVAs. After the initial configuration, the user accesses and monitors the entire solution via the SVM Dashboard. This chapter provides a functional overview of the SVM, the SVP and the SVA. The following topics are covered within this chapter: IP Correlation Engine (ICE) SVM SVP SVA SVM Dashboard
2.1
ICE Correlation
As the name suggests, this key technology automatically correlates the real-time state and changes in the IP network to the individual sessions being carried through that network. In real-time, CEM calculates the exact hop-by-hop path of any session, and can identify what network or signaling event has impacted, or is impacting, that session. Further, this same knowledge is used to proactively alert the service manager to changes in network configuration that can impact the traffic on the network. Unique aspects of the IP Correlation Engine include: Works in real time to create a service assurance mashup, providing a dynamic "map" of the network onto which media and application/service information is correlated. Monitors the network without imposing any burden on the deployed network nodes, such as routers; it passively participates in the routed network using standard IP routing protocols.
The results of the ICE correlation are presented in the Quality of Session Record (QSR).
1-2
Introduction
2.2
SVM
The Service Visibility Manager is a management node for the SVPs and SVAs deployed in a network. For each application, the SVM provides metrics applicable to that application. In addition, the SVM provides Fault, Configuration, Accounting, Performance, and Security (FCAPS) management for the SVPs deployed. The SVM receives operational information from all the SVPs within the network, which is then displayed on the SVM Dashboard. SNMP traps can be used to provide the operators NMS/OSS with SVM fault/alarm information. The SVM supports SNMP v1 and v2c for this purpose.
2.3
SVP
The Service Visibility Point monitors signaling traffic (i.e., sessions) in a routed IP network. SVPs collect signaling traffic from applications that terminate call processing signaling and control streams. The CEM network stores information pertaining to these sessions, and provides real-time and historical operational statistics for them. The SVP passively monitors signaling information exchanged between signaling terminations points (e.g., call processing applications, IP phones, VoIP gateways, SIP proxies and Session Border Controllers). The definition of a signaling session is described below. In essence, a signaling session is bidirectional signaling information streamed between these signaling termination points and spans the time from the start of the signaling session to the end of that session. A call may (and probably does!) consist of multiple signaling sessions When used in a Microsoft Lync environment, the signaling monitoring function is p erformed by the Lync solution. Signaling information from Lync Front End servers is abstracted and delivered to an SVP through the Lync Network Diagnostics (LND) API. The SVP captures this signaling information and transforms it to signaling session information that is presented in the SVMs Dashboard in a similar format to that of signaling sessions monitored directly by the SVP. This monitoring approach is required because the Lync signaling stream information is encrypted. In addition to signaling session information, the LND API delivers quality of experience (QoE) information to the SVP related to the quality of the end-to-end media stream. This information can be used to supplement the QoE information delivered by the SVA. The SVP also discovers network topology and status of available network resources by using standard IP routing protocols, such as OSPF and BGP, and by collecting information from the monitored routers using SNMP and CLI. Through BGP or OSPF polling, the SVP can construct, at any time, the hop-by-hop path taken by media streams from their source to their destination. For any call, the SVP can then precisely determine the calls source and destination endpoints, the precise hop-by-hop path that the calls media streams takes from source to destination endpoint and can exclude router service degradation events from those events by routers identified as NOT being in the calls media path. All of this information is correlated by the SVP to the collected signaling and media sessions of the aggregate call. As signaling stream sessions and media streams are established and released during a call, the SVP maintains operational metrics about each session. If these metrics deviate outside the normal operational range (based on user defined thresholds), the SVP alerts the Operations team of potential problems and provides a list of affected sessions. This allows proactive management of the network and can significantly reduce the Mean Time to Isolate (MTTI) during problem resolution.
1-3
Introduction
2.4
SVA
The Service Visibility Analyzer analyzes voice and video media streams associated with the sessions monitored by an SVP. Within a single, aggregate call, one or more media legs can exist between the source and destination endpoints that terminate the call s media, A media session is defined as any media (sequence of voice or video packets) stream that is terminated between two media terminating endpoints (e.g., IP phone, Session Border Controller, VoIP gateway, conference bridge application, etc.). Multiple media sessions of a call can and do take different paths through the routed network than the multiple signaling sessions of that same call. SVAs capture media stream packets and perform calculations on the data contained within these media packets that yield Quality of Experience (QoE MOS scores, number of packets lost, jitter, media packet delay). The QoE calculated information is correlated in the SVP with its specific signaling session and presented in the SVM dashboard for analysis and diagnostics.
2.4.1
2.4.2
2.5
SVM Dashboard
The SVM contains a web server to enable access to the SVM Dashboard using industry standard web browsers such as Chrome, Firefox, and Internet Explorer. The Dashboard can be accessed from any personal workstation within an operators network where the SVM is deployed. It presents information about the SVM-monitored domain in an easily understood and meaningful format and allows a user to run various searches and reports, while analyzing a network issue. The SVM Dashboard presents information about SVPs, SVAs and the operators network in
1-4
Introduction
both tabular and graphical formats. There are two SVM dashboards graphical user interfaces (GUI) that can be used for operations. The legacy dashboard GUI is referred to as the orange GUI. The newer GUI is referred to as the blue GUI. The blue GUI was developed to improve operational workflows in a help desk environment.
2.6
The media, or content, structure is shown in the following figure. The media (voice, video) streams are comprised of all voice or video packet streams that pass through media termination points, which are the SBC and the source computer in the figure. A media leg is the media stream passing between two media points, such as the computers, SBC and routers that terminate a media stream. It is important to recognize the distinction between a device that terminates media (such as an IP phone or an SBC or a VoIP gateway) and a device that forwards media such as a router or switch. In the example, the media has two legs, each of which has three legs. An SVA can monitor one stream, which includes one or more media legs.
1-5
Introduction
The following shows an example implementation of an SVP and two SVAs. The SVP can monitor four sessions, which in the example includes sessions 1, 2, 3, and 5. It does not monitor the session between the SBC and the destination call manager. If a support staff found a session with an alert, he could use the Find Related Sessions query to search for the other monitored sessions that were part of the same call.
Similarly, the SVAs cannot monitor an entire media stream but can monitor the individual media legs. In this example, SVA-DAL is connected to the DAL-CE2 router and monitors the media stream exiting from the DAL-CE2 router. Similarly, SVA-NY is connected to the 03-NewYork router and monitors the media stream from the destination end-point to the SBC. The following figure shows an alternative configuration, in which a Lync Server is used with the source end-point. The figure shows a hybrid environment with Lync and another call manager system. The SVP receives quality of experience (QoE) and signaling data from the Lync server
1-6
Introduction
using the LND API through the SVPs management interface, not a monitoring port. The Lync server provides QoE media data for the encrypted Lync sessions, and the Lync client applications function similarly to SVAs by providing the QoE data for the inbound media stream to the Lync client. The SVP collects data from other sessions that are not Lync encrypted.
In the QSR window, the source-to-destination and destination-to-source metrics include data from all monitoring points in the media stream, which includes each router or switch connected to an SVA and each Lync client endpoint. For example, in the following figure, the QSR window shows two columns of destination-to-source data. One SVA (DAL-SVA-CE1) retrieves and displays data from a router, shown as 1 in the figure. Another SVA (DAL-SVA-CE2) gets data from another router, marked as 2 in the figure. If a Lync server were used (as in Figure 2-4), its data would be presented in a separate column as Endpoint Statistics.
1-7
Introduction
1-8
3.1
1U Server
Letter A B C D
Description Serial port VGA connector USB ports Management interface (nnet0)
3-1
3.2
2U Server
Letter A B C D E F
Location Front Panel Front Panel Rear Panel Rear Panel Rear Panel Rear Panel
Description Serial port USB port Serial port VGA connector USB ports Management interface (nnet0)
3.3
3-2
3.4
3.4.1
Pin 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Signal RTS (Request to Send) DTR (Data Terminal Ready) TXD (Transmit Data) GND RIA (Ring Indicator) RXD (Receive Data) DSR/DCD (Data set Ready / Data Carrier Detect CTS (Clear to Send)
To connect a PC to the system a RJ-45 to DB-9 adapter will be required. The pinout for this adapter is provided in the table below.
Table 3-4 - RJ-45 to DB-9 Adapter Pinout
SVM/SVP/SVA RJ-45 Serial Port Signal RTS DTR TXD GND RIA RXD DSR/DCD CTS Pin 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Pin 8 6 2 5 5 3 4 7
PC DB-9 Serial Port Signal CTS DSR RXD GND GND TXD DTR RTS
The serial port on the NetSocket servers has the same pinouts as Cisco routers and switches. Therefore, console cables that can be used to connect to a Cisco device may also be used to connect to a NetSocket server. Note that the NetSocket serial port uses a higher baud rate than Cisco devices as shown in the table below.
3-3
Setting Baud Rate Data Bits Parity Stop Bits Flow Control
3.4.2
3.5
3-4
4
4.1
CLI Basics
This chapter provides information about the Command Line Interface (CLI) used to provision the NetSocket SVP, SVA, and SVM.
Command Structure
In its basic form, a CLI command can be thought of as a single-word command followed by possible mandatory or optional keywords and arguments. However, when forming names of CLI commands for documentation purposes, the single-word command is often combined with mandatory keyword choices to produce one or more commands. For example, the show alarms and show aliases CLI commands are documented as two separate commands instead of a single show command with alarms and aliases as keyword choices. This breakdown of large commands into smaller units is done so that the resulting commands can be more effectively located and understood by the user of the documentation.
4.1.1
Command Classes
The CLI command set is comprised of three classes of commands: Configuration, Monitoring, and Operations. The Configuration class of commands includes all commands that allow a user to create, modify, or delete persistent configuration information within the SVP, SVA, and SVM. Configuration commands are available within various configuration command modes. The Monitoring class of commands includes all commands that allow a user to retrieve configuration and status information from the system. Monitoring commands are available entirely within the EXEC command mode. The Operations class of commands includes all commands that allow a user to initiate specific functions of the system, but not to change any configuration information. Operations commands are available entirely within the EXEC command mode.
4.1.2
Command Modes
The CLI contains a hierarchical structure for accessing commands. Sets of commands are available within different command modes located at various levels within the hierarchical structure. The left column of the following table lists the names of all supported command modes. For configuration command modes that vary the set of commands available depending upon the type of object being configured, a command mode qualifier is also specified as part of the command mode. The command mode qualifier is simply the name for the type of object being configured, enclosed within parentheses. By default, the CLI prompt indicates the current command mode. The right column lists the CLI default prompt values for each command mode. The contents of the CLI prompt can be customized using the prompt command.
CLI Basics
Command Mode User EXEC Privileged EXEC Global Configuration Address Family Configuration (at-type) Flow Aggregation Cache Configuration Interface Configuration (entity-type) IP Extended Access-List Configuration IP Standard Access-List Configuration Route-Map Assign Route-Map Configuration Router Configuration (protocol) Session-Thresholds Subinterface Configuration (entity-type) Traceoptions Configuration Topology Map Topology Map Router Router> Router# Router(config)#
Prompt
Router(config-router-af)# Router(config-flow-cache)# Router(config-if)# Router(config-ext-nacl)# Router(config-std-nacl)# Router(route-map-assign)# Router(config-route-map)# Router(config-router)# Router(config- session-threshold) Router(config-subif)# Router(config-traceoptions)# Router (config-topology-map)# Router (config-topology-map-router)#
When establishing a connection with the CLI, the user is placed in the EXEC command mode. The EXEC command mode has 16 possible privilege levels (ranging from 0 to 15), but by default, the user starts at privilege level 1, or the User level. When at the User level, the EXEC command mode is referred to as the User EXEC Mode. The User EXEC Mode has a limited set of commands made available to the user. To gain access to additional commands at a higher privilege level, the user enters the enable command (followed by a password if configured). As an initial system default, all commands not available at the User level are available at privilege level 15, referred to as the Privileged level. When at the Privileged level, the EXEC command mode is referred to as the Privileged EXEC Mode. Once the user is in the Privileged EXEC Mode, all other command modes are accessible. The Global Configuration Mode can be used to configure items that are of a non-specific nature. From the Privileged EXEC Mode, the user enters the configure command to move to the Global Configuration Mode. From the Global Configuration Mode, a number of specific configuration modes can also be reached by entering the specific configuration mode entry command. For example, the Controller Configuration Mode can be reached from the Global Configuration Mode by entering controller (followed by a controller entity-name). By using a small set of commands, a user can move from one command mode to another. For a complete list of all mode navigation commands, see the following table.
4-2
CLI Basics
From I To from EXEC to User EXEC (creates a new session) from User EXEC to Privileged EXEC from Privileged EXEC to User EXEC (creates a new session) from Privileged EXEC to Global Configuration from Global Configuration to any configuration mode from any configuration mode to Global Configuration from any configuration mode to back one mode from any configuration mode to Privileged EXEC from Privileged EXEC to User EXEC from any EXEC mode to log off router exit (config) end disable (EXEC) login enable login configure
Command
4.1.3
Command Syntax
As an aid in conveying CLI syntax requirements, command syntax conventions have been adopted within the command documentation. These syntax conventions are summarized below.
Table 4-3 - Syntax Conventions
Syntax Convention bold italics output In Progress ... a [a] ... I * [a]...
Description Bold indicates keywords input exactly as shown Italic type indicates arguments that must be supplied by the user Non-proportional font indicates output from the router Output message indicates the entered command is in progress Nothing indicates required keyword, argument, or combination Brackets indicate optional keyword, argument, or combination Ellipsis, pipe, and asterisk indicate operators of an expression Brackets followed by an ellipsis indicate optional one or more unique instances of an argument, expression, or combination
4-3
CLI Basics
{a}...
Braces followed by an ellipsis indicate required one or more unique instances of an argument, expression, or combination
[a I b] {a I b}
Brackets separated by one or more pipes indicate optional choice of a keyword, argument, expression, or combination Braces separated by one or more pipes indicate required choice of a keyword, argument, expression, or combination
*[a I b]
Brackets preceded by an asterisk and separated by one or more pipes indicate optional one or more non-ordered choices of a keyword, argument, expression, or combination Braces preceded by an asterisk and separated by one or more pipes indicate required one or more non-ordered choices of a keyword, argument, expression, or combination
*{a I b}
4.2
4.2.1
CLI Fundamentals
CLI Functions
The CLI allows unique abbreviations to be substituted within commands in place of fully entered keywords (and certain arguments). This function is merely a time-saving feature to be used or not used by preference of the user. The CLI provides command-line help functions to assist the user in forming valid command input. The following table summarizes the available command-line help functions and how to access them. Note that help is only offered for the commands that are valid within the current command mode.
Table 4-4 - Command-Line Help
Help Function Show command-line help information Show a list of all available commands Show commands starting with given input Show available keywords and arguments Auto-complete command or keyword
How to Access Type help and then the enter key Type ? Type ? after entering input Type a command, a space, and then ? Type first letter(s) and then the tab key
The CLI provides a set of command-line editing functions. These functions are invoked by special key combinations. A list of these key combinations and corresponding functions is shown below. Note that a dash (-) means two keys must be pressed at the same time.
4-4
CLI Basics
Key Combination Ctrl-a {Ctrl-b I lt arrow} Ctrl-e {Ctrl-f I rt arrow} {del I backspace} Ctrl-d Ctrl-k {Ctrl-u I Ctrl-x} Ctrl-w Ctrl-t {Ctrl-p I up arrow} {Ctrl-n I dn arrow}
Function Move cursor to the start of the line being edited Move cursor backward one character (to the left) Move cursor to the end of the line being edited Move cursor forward one character (to the right) Delete character to the left of the cursor Delete character directly under cursor Delete characters from the cursor to the end of the line being edited Delete characters from the cursor to the start of the line being edited Delete entire word to the left of the cursor Transpose character under the cursor with the character to the left Display older command within the command history buffer Display newer command within the command history buffer
The CLI provides the capability within all show commands to filter out certain lines in the output based on matching a regular expression string. By simply appending the output modifier syntax shown in the following table to the normal show command syntax, the corresponding filter function can be applied. Note that the reg-exp (regular expression) argument of the output modifier syntax is case sensitive. If the regular expression string includes one or more spaces to be used in the filtering criteria, parentheses must be used as delimiters.
Table 4-6 - Show Output Filtering
Function Display show output beginning at line matched by reg-exp string Display show output including all lines matched by reg-exp string Display show output excluding all lines matched by reg-exp string
The CLI provides the capability to enter and display numeric constants using multiple formats based on special prefixes applied to the constant. The following table shows the prefixes understood by the CLI and the corresponding meaning.
Table 4-7 - Numeric Constant Prefixes
Prefix (none) 0 0x
Meaning Numeric constant is interpreted as decimal (base 10) Numeric constant is interpreted as octal (base 8) Numeric constant is interpreted as hexadecimal (base 16)
4-5
CLI Basics
While displaying output that exceeds the length of a single display screen, the CLI provides a paging capability that allows entry of various paging-related commands. These CLI paging commands are listed below.
Table 4-8 - Paging Commands
Command :help [n] {f I Ctrl-f I space} [n] {b I Ctrl-b} [n] {j I cr} [n] k [n] {d I Ctrl-d} [n] {u I Ctrl-u} [n] g {r I Ctrl-l} [n] Ipattern [n] I!pattern [n] ?pattern [n] ?!pattern [n] n [n] N {= I Ctrl-g} {q I :q I ZZ}
Function Display paging command help Forward n lines, default one screen Backward n lines, default one screen Forward n lines, default one line Backward n lines, default one line Forward n lines, default half screen or last n Backward n lines, default half screen or last n Go to line n, default line 1 Repaint screen Search forward for nth line containing the pattern Search forward for nth line not containing the pattern Search backward for nth line containing the pattern Search backward for nth line not containing the pattern Repeat previous search (for nth occurrence) Repeat previous search other direction (for nth occurrence) Display current status Exit
Finally, the CLI provides many powerful utilities that can be accessed by the user. These CLI utilities are listed below.
Table 4-9 - Utility Commands
Utility Sends an asynchronous user message to another user Opens a telnet connection with a remote host Sends an asynchronous user message to all users
4-6
CLI Basics
4.2.2 CLI Customization
Some aspects of the CLI can be modified to accommodate the individual needs of the user. The CLI commands and corresponding functions that provide this level of CLI customization are listed below.
Table 4-10 - CLI Customization Commands
Command alias banner enable banner exec banner login banner motd enable password exec-banner exec-timeout motd-banner privilege level prompt terminal history terminal length terminal monitor terminal width
Function Sets a command alias to be used instead of an original command Sets a message to display upon enabling to a new privilege level Sets a message to display after user login Sets a message to display before user login Sets a message of the day (MOTD) message Sets a password to control access to a specified privilege level Enables both the EXEC and message of the day (MOTD) banners Sets the EXEC time-out period Enables the message of the day (MOTD) banner Assigns a privilege level to a command Enables a custom prompt string to be configured Enables the command history feature or sets the command buffer size Sets the number of display lines per screen Enables output of debug and error messages Sets the number of characters per display line
4-7
5-1
Sends an accounting notice only when a process ends. Include the TACACS+ method.
5-2
Include the local user name database method. Include the RADIUS servers method. Include the TACACS+ servers method.
Mode Global Configuration Guidelines If the default login AAA authentication method list does not exist, the local user name database is used as the default login AAA authentication method list.
default
local
5-3
tacacs+
Mode
5-4
aar
Average Active Registrations (AAR) is an average number of active registrations. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. This alert can be used if a known minimum number of registrations is expected. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the AAR alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the AAR alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS. The set threshold must be less than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax aar {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } no aar {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter interval1 interval2 interval3 interval4 set Description set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. If number of active tunnels is less than this value, alert will set. If number of active tunnels is greater than or equal to this value, alert will clear. 0 to 300,000 where 00 implies off. 00 to 300,000 Type/Range Default None None None None 0
clear
5-5
aat
Average Active Tunnels (AAT) is an average number of active tunnels. This alert can be used if a known minimum number of tunnels expected. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the AAT alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the AAT alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS. The set threshold must be less than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax aat {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } no aat {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter interval1 interval2 interval3 interval4 set Description set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. If number of active tunnels is less than this value, alert will set. If number of active tunnels is greater than or equal to this value, alert will clear. 0 to 300,000 where 00 implies off. 00 to 300,000 Type/Range Default None None None None 0
clear
access-list (extended)
5-6
ip source-ip-address sourcewildmask any host source-ip-address dest-ip-address destwildmask any host dest-ip-address
5-7
dscp-value
DSCP value to be matched, range is 0 to 63, or a wellknown DSCP name, or symbol-name if defined in define dscp. Precedence level to be matched, valid entries are 0 to 7, or a well-known precedence name, or symbol-name if defined in define ip-precedence. Service level to be matched, range is 0 to 15, or a wellknown ToS name (SVP option only). Specifies that information about matching packets will be sent to the console. Specifies that the input interface is to be included in the log. Specifies that packets in IP datagram fragments are to be matched (SVP option only). Text about or explanation of the access-list, up to 100 characters long. Name of an existing class-map (created with class-map command) to which the access-list is being applied.
precedence-value
5-8
5-9
See the access-list (extended) command for other descriptions of inputs that are common between the access-list family of commands. Syntax access-list access-list-id [seq sequence-number] {{deny | permit} {6 | tcp} {source-ipaddress source-wildmask | any | host source-ip-address} [{eq | gt | lt | neq} source-tcp-port | range source-tcp-port1 source-tcp-port2] {dest-ip-address dest-wildmask | any | host dest-ipaddress} [{eq | gt | lt | neq} dest-tcp-port | range dest-tcp-port1 dest-tcp-port2] *[dscp dscp-value | precedence precedence-value | tos tos-value | {log | log-input} | fragments | ack | established | fin | psh | rst | syn | urg] | remark string} [class-map class-map-name] no access-list access-list-id [seq sequence-number] [{deny | permit} {6 | tcp} {sourceipaddress source-wildmask | any | host source-ip-address} [{eq | gt | lt | neq} source-tcp-port | range source-tcp-port1 source-tcp-port2] {dest-ip-address dest-wildmask | any | host destipaddress} [{eq | gt | lt | neq} dest-tcp-port | range dest-tcp-port1 dest-tcp-port2] *[dscp dscpvalue | precedence precedence-value | tos tos-value | {log | log-input} | fragments | ack | established | fin | psh | rst | syn | urg] | remark string] [class-map class-map-name] Parameters Parameter eq gt lt neq range source-tcp-port dest-tcp-port ack established fin psh rst syn urg Mode Global Configuration Description Specifies that port must be equal to a value. Specifies that port must be greater than a value. Specifies that port must be less than a value. Specifies that port must be not equal to a value. Specifies that port must be within a range of values. Decimal number or well-known name of the source TCP port, or symbol name if defined in define tcp-port. Decimal number or well-known name of the destination TCP port, or symbol name if defined in define tcp-port. TCP flag to be matched (SVP option only). TCP flag to be matched (SVP option only). TCP flag to be matched (SVP option only). TCP flag to be matched (SVP option only). TCP flag to be matched (SVP option only). TCP flag to be matched (SVP option only). TCP flag to be matched (SVP option only).
5-10
access-list sequence-enable
Enables the display of sequence numbers when showing access-lists. The no form of this command disables the display of sequence numbers when showing access-lists (default).
5-11
This command does not affect access-list commands displayed within running configuration output. Sequence numbers are not displayed within running configuration output. Syntax access-list sequence-enable no access-list sequence-enable Mode Global Configuration
access-list (standard)
Creates a standard access-list. If no sequence number or matching clause is specified, the no form of this command deletes the entire access-list; otherwise, only the access-list clause specified by the sequence number and/or matching clause is deleted. Syntax access-list access-list-id [seq sequence-number] {{deny | permit} {ip-address [wildmask] | any | host ip-address} [log] | remark string} [class-map class-map-name] no access-list access-list-id [seq sequence-number] [{deny | permit} {ip-address [wildmask] | any | host ip-address} [log] | remark string] [class-map class-map-name] Parameters Parameter access-list-id sequence-number Description Alphanumeric name string (40 characters maximum) of the standard access-list being defined. Unique sequence number of the deny, permit, or remark clause being added to (or deleted from) the access list; by default, sequence numbers start at 10 and increment by 10 for each entry added to the end of the access list. Access is denied for the source addresses specified. Access is permitted for the source addresses specified. Access is denied or permitted for packets originating from this source IP address and wildcard mask combination (if wildcard mask is not specified, 0.0.0.0 is assumed). Access is denied or permitted for packets originating from any source IP address. Access is denied or permitted for packets originating from this source IP address host.
5-12
Specifies that information about matching packets will be sent to the console. Text about or explanation of the access-list, up to 100 characters long. Name of an existing class-map (created with class-map command) to which the access-list is being applied.
acd
Average Call Duration (ACD) is an average duration of successfully connected calls from the beginning of the call request to the release of the call. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the ACD alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the ACD alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS. The set threshold must be less than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax acd {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } no acd {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter interval1 interval2 interval3 interval4 set Description set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. Value of duration in seconds is less than this value, alert will set. 0 to 600 where 00 implies off. Type/Range Default None None None None 0
5-13
clear
Value of duration in seconds is greater than or equal to this value, alert will clear.
00 to 600
acdd
Average Call Disconnect Delay (ACDD) is an average delay for VoIP sessions measured from the release request to the acknowledgement. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the ACDD alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the ACDD alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS based on the Average Call Disconnect Delay. The set threshold must be greater than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax acdd {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } no acdd {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter interval1 interval2 interval3 interval4 set Description set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. Value of duration in seconds is greater than this value, alert will set. 0 to 600 where 00 implies off. Type/Range Default None None None None 0
5-14
clear
Value of duration in seconds is less than or equal to this value, alert will clear.
00 to 600
add
Average Data Duration (ADD) is an average duration of successfully established data sessions. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the ADD alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the ADD alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS based on the Average Data Duration. The set threshold must be less than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax add {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } no add {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter interval1 interval2 interval3 interval4 set Description set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. Value of duration in seconds is less than this value, alert will set. Value of duration in seconds is greater than or equal to this value, alert will clear. 0 to 300 where 00 implies off. 00 to 300 Type/Range Default None None None None 0
clear
5-15
address-family ipv4
Enables IPv4 address family based running configuration on the RCP and enters into the specified Address Family Configuration Mode. The no form of this command does a no activate command on all peers and peer groups in the address family, removes all peers from their peer groups, and clears out all the attributes from peers. Syntax address-family ipv4 [multicast | [unicast] [vrf vrf-name]] no address-family ipv4 [multicast | [unicast] [vrf vrf-name]] Parameters Parameter ipv4 multicast unicast vrf-name Description Specifies IP version 4 Specifies Multicast mode. Specifies Unicast mode (default). Alpha-numeric-symbolic name for the VRF the address-family information is associated with, range is 1 to 40 characters.
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Guidelines Once address family based running configuration is enabled on the RCP, it cannot be disabled.
address-family (traceoptions)
Enables debug messages of specified BGP address family names to be placed in the trace file. The no form of this command disables debug messages of specified BGP address family names (or all names if none specified) from being placed in the trace file (default). Syntax address-family {family-name}... no address-family [family-name]...
5-16
alias
Creates a command alias for a specified command within a specified command mode. The no form of this command deletes a specified command alias within a specified mode or deletes all command aliases within a specified mode. Syntax alias mode command-alias command no alias mode [command-alias [command]] Parameters Parameter mode Description {address-family | configure | controller | cos-queue-group-in | cos-queuegroupout | exec | flow-cache | interface | ipexplicit-path | ipenacl | ipsnacl | line | path-attr | policy-list | protmon | QoSclassmap | QoSpolicymap-in | QoSpolicymap-out | QoSpolicymapclassin | QoSpolicymapclass-out | route-map | router | subinterface | traceoptions}. Address Family Configuration Mode. Global Configuration Mode. EXEC mode. Flow aggregation Cache Configuration Mode. Interface Configuration Mode. IP Explicit Path Configuration Mode. IP Extended Access-List Configuration Mode.
5-17
ipsnacl line path-attr policy-list protmon route-map router subinterface traceoptions Mode Global Configuration
IP Standard Access-List Configuration Mode. Line Configuration Mode. Path Attribute Configuration Mode. IP Policy List Configuration Mode. Protection Monitor Configuration Mode Route-Map Configuration Mode. Router Configuration Mode. Subinterface Configuration Mode. Traceoptions Configuration Mode.
apdd
Average Post Dial Delay (APDD) is an average delay for VoIP sessions measured from the call request to ringing. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the ACRD alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the APDD alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS. The set threshold must be greater than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax apdd {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } no apdd {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter interval1 interval2 interval3 Description set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. Type/Range Default None None None
5-18
interval4 set
set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. Value of duration in seconds is greater than this value, alert will set. Value of duration in seconds is less than or equal to this value, alert will clear. 0 to 600 where 00 implies off. 00 to 600
None 0
clear
ard
Average Registration Delay (ARD) is the average delay for VoIP applications for registration delay duration. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the ARD alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the ARD alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS based on the Average Registration Delay. The set threshold must be greater than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax ard {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } no ard {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter interval1 interval2 interval3 interval4 Description set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. Type/Range Default None None None None
5-19
set
Value of duration in seconds is greater than this value, alert will set. Value of duration in seconds is less than or equal to this value, alert will clear.
clear
area authentication
Enables authentication in the OSPF area specified. The no form of this command disables authentication for the area (default). Syntax area {ip-address | area-id} authentication [simple | message-digest] no area {ip-address | area-id} authentication [simple | message-digest] Parameters Parameter ip-address Description Area to be authenticated, expressed as an IP address (dotted decimal). Area to be authenticated, expressed as a decimal number Specifies Type-1 (simple password) authentication (default). Specifies MD5 authentication. 0 to 4294967295 Type/Range
area-id
simple
message-digest
Mode Router Configuration (OSPF) Guidelines If simple or message-digest is not specified, simple authentication is done.
5-20
area default-cost
In an Area Border Router (ABR), specifies the cost of the default summary route sent into a stub area. The no form of this command removes the specified default summary route cost, and sets the default-cost to 1 (default). Syntax area {ip-address | area-id} default-cost cost no area {ip-address | area-id} default-cost [cost] Parameters Parameter ip-address Description IPv4 or IPv6 address of the area into which the defaultcost is being sent. Area into which the defaultcost is being sent, expressed as a decimal number Default summary route cost for the stub area Type/Range IPv4 or IPv6
area-id
0 to 4294967295
cost
1 to 65535, default is 1.
area nssa
Enables an OSPF area to be a not-so-stubby-area (NSSA). The no form of this command removes an OSPF area from NSSA designation. Syntax area {ip-address | area-id} nssa [no-redistribution] [default-information-originate] [nosummary] no area {ip-address | area-id} nssa [no-redistribution] [default-information-originate] [nosummary] Parameters Parameter Description Type/Range
5-21
ip-address
Area being designated as an NSSA, expressed as an ip address (dotted decimal). Area being designated as an NSSA, expressed as a decimal number Configures this router (which must be an NSSA Area Border Router) to not redistribute routes into the NSSA, but to allow redistribution into the nonNSSA areas. Configures this router to not send Network Summary LSAs (Type 3) into the NSSA Configures this router (which must be an NSSA Area Border Router) to generate an NSSA External LSA (Type 7) default route into the NSSA. 0 to 4294967295
area-id
no-redistribution
no-summary
default-informationoriginate
area virtual-link
Sets an OSPF virtual link (a link to the backbone through a non-backbone area). The no form of this command removes the virtual link. Syntax area {ip-address | area-id} virtual-link router-id *[authentication [null | message-digest] | dead-interval seconds | hello-interval seconds | retransmit-interval seconds | transmitdelay seconds] [authentication-key [encryption-type] password | message-digest-key key-id md5 [encryption-type] key] no area {ip-address | area-id} virtual-link router-id *[authentication [null | message-digest] | dead-interval seconds | hello-interval seconds | retransmit-interval seconds | transmitdelay seconds] [authentication-key [encryption-type] password | message-digest-key key-id md5 [encryption-type] key] Parameters
5-22
Parameter ip-address
Description IP address of the area of the non-backbone (transit) area being used for the virtual link. Area of the non-backbone (transit) area being used for the virtual link Router-id of the ABR with which the virtual-link is being established. Amount of time in seconds that passes between the sending of Hello packets. Amount of time in seconds to wait between unacknowledged OSPF packet retransmissions Amount of time in seconds it takes to transmit an LSA on this interface. The LSA age will be increased by this amount as it exits this interface or resides in the LSA database Amount of time in seconds that the RCP will wait to hear a Hello from a neighbor on the network to which the interface is connected before declaring the neighbor dead (down) Configures the link to use simple (password) authentication. Configures the link to use no authentication. Configures the link to use MD5 authentication. Optional number specifying the type of encryption to use when storing and displaying the simple password
Type/Range
area-id
0 to 4294967295
router-id
hello-interval seconds
1 to 8192, default is 10
retransmit-interval seconds
1 to 8192, default is 5
transmit-delay seconds
1 to 8192, default is 1
dead-interval seconds
1 to 8192, default is 40
authentication
5-23
password
Continuous string of characters, up to 8 bytes long, that is the simple password to be used by neighboring routers. Identifier for the MD5 key Optional number specifying the type of encryption to use when storing and displaying the md5 key Alphanumeric string of up to 16 characters that is the value of the MD5 key. 1 to 255 0 to 7, default is 0 (no encryption).
key
Mode Router Configuration (OSPF) Guidelines If the command password-encryption has been enabled, all passwords are encrypted for storage and display, regardless of the encryption type parameters specified here.
arp
Creates a static entry within the Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) table. The no form of this command removes a static entry. Syntax arp ip-address mac-address no arp ip-address [mac-address] Parameters Parameter ip-address mac-address Description IP address of the static entry. 48-bit IEEE MAC address using three 4-digit hex numbers separated by periods (xxxx.xxxx.xxxx)
5-24
assign
Creates a variable that can have multiple match commands associated with it, so that more than one match condition may exist for a set command. The no form of this command deletes the variable definition. Syntax assign variable-name no assign variable-name Parameters Parameter variable-name Description Name of the variable being created, can be one alphabetic character a-z Type/Range
Mode Route-Map Configuration Guidelines This command enters Route-Map Assign Mode, where all of the route-map match commands are available. After entering the match commands to be assigned to this variable, type exit to return to normal Route-Map Configuration Mode.
atd
Average Tunnel Duration (ATD) is an average duration of successfully established tunnel sessions. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the ATD alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the ATD alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS based on the Average Tunnel Duration. The set threshold must be less than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax atd {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } no atd {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters
5-25
Description set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. Value of duration in seconds is less than this value, alert will set. Value of duration in seconds is greater than or equal to this value, alert will clear.
Type/Range
clear
avd
Average Video Duration (AVD) is an average duration of successfully connected video session from the beginning of the request to the release of the session. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the AVD alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the AVD alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS. The set threshold must be less than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax avd {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } no avd {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter interval1 Description set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. Type/Range Default None
5-26
set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. Value of duration in seconds is less than this value, alert will set. Value of duration in seconds is greater than or equal to this value, alert will clear. 0 to 600 where 00 implies off. 00 to 600
clear
avdd
Average Video Disconnect Delay (AVDD) is the average from the request for termination until the acknowledgement. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the AVDD alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the AVDD alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS based on the Average Video Disconnect Delay. The set threshold must be greater than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax avdd {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } no avdd {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter interval1 interval2 Description set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. Type/Range Default None None
5-27
set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. Value of duration in seconds is greater than this value, alert will set. Value of duration in seconds is less than or equal to this value, alert will clear. 0 to 600 where 00 implies off. 00 to 600
None None 0
clear
avpdd
Average Video Post Dial Delay (AVPDD) is the average delay from the initial request to the ringing. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the AVPDD alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the AVPDD alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS. The set threshold must be greater than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax avpdd {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } no avpdd {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter interval1 interval2 interval3 interval4 Description set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. Type/Range Default None None None None
5-28
set
Value of duration in seconds is greater than this value, alert will set. Value of duration in seconds is less than or equal to this value, alert will clear.
clear
bandwidth (interface)
Sets the bandwidth informational value for an interface. The no form of this command sets the bandwidth informational value to the default value. Syntax bandwidth kilobits no bandwidth [kilobits] Parameters Parameter kilobits Description Bandwidth in kilobits per second Type/Range Range is 1 to 80000000, default values are 9 for Tunnel; 10000 for Admin and NNET; and Loopback, and Null. For Port-chan and Pos-chan, the default is for the bandwidth value to be dynamically set according to the number of active members. Subinterface defaults are same as parent interface.
Mode Interface Configuration (Admin, Em, Loopback, NNET, Null, Tunnel) Guidelines When an interface is assigned as a member of a link bundle interface, the bandwidth value for that interface is changed to the default value for that interface. Once an interface is removed as
5-29
banner enable
Sets a message to display upon enabling to a new privilege level. The no form of this command deletes an existing message (default). Syntax banner enable c message c no banner enable [c message c] Parameters Parameter c Description Delimiting character, any character is allowed but it must use a different character than any used in the banner message. Banner message text.
If desired, a message can span multiple lines by using a carriage return. The RCP will continue to allow additional lines until a line is entered containing an ending delimiting character.
banner exec
Sets a message to display after user login. The no form of this command deletes an existing message (default). Syntax banner exec c message c no banner exec [c message c]
5-30
message
banner login
Sets a message to display before user login. The no form of this command deletes an existing message (default). Syntax banner login c message c no banner login [c message c] Parameters Parameter c Description Delimiting character, any character is allowed but it must use a different character than any used in the banner message. Banner message text.
message
banner motd
Sets a message-of-the-day (MOTD) message to display before login message. The no form of this command deletes an existing message (default). Syntax banner motd c message c
5-31
message
bgp
Enables the RCP to allow any integer as a valid router ID, including 0. The no form of this command enables the RCP to reject bad router IDs (default). Syntax bgp allow-illegal-routerid no bgp allow-illegal-routerid Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF)
5-32
bgp cluster-id
Sets the cluster ID for the routers acting as route reflectors if the BGP cluster has more than one route reflector. The no form of this command removes the cluster ID. Syntax bgp cluster-id cluster-id no bgp cluster-id [cluster-id] Parameters Parameter cluster-id Description Cluster ID of this route reflector expressed as a nonzero-32-bit-integer (1 to 4294967295) or a dotted decimal IP address.
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Multicast)
5-33
bgp fast-external-fallover
Enables the BGP sessions of any directly adjacent external peers to immediately reset if the link used to reach them goes down (default). The no form of this command disables this function. Syntax bgp fast-external-fallover no bgp fast-external-fallover Modes Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF)
bgp log-neighbor-changes
5-34
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF)
bgp peer-restart-timer
Sets the time gap between the command that is the cause of the peer reset and the actual peer reset. The no form of this command returns the timers to their default values. Syntax bgp peer-restart-timer {level-1 time-in-seconds | level-2 time-in-seconds | level-3 timeinseconds} no bgp peer-restart-timer {level-1 [time-in-seconds] | level-2 [time-in-seconds] | level-3 [timein-seconds]} Parameters Parameter level-1 time-inseconds Description Period of time between the trigger event and the peer reset for level-1 restart timers Period of time between the trigger event and the peer reset for level-2 restart timers Type/Range 0 to 180 30 Default
level-2 time-inseconds
0 to 180
20
5-35
level-3 time-inseconds
Period of time between the trigger event and the peer reset for level-3 restart timers
0 to 180,
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Guidelines This command is not available in Address-family Router Configuration Mode.
bgp reset-peer-on-illegal-nexthop
Enables the RCP to shut down a peering session when an illegal next-hop is received from that peer. The no form of this command causes BGP to ignore incoming routes with illegal nexthops and keep the peering session up (default). Syntax bgp reset-peer-on-illegal-nexthop no bgp reset-peer-on-illegal-nexthop Modes Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Guidelines Illegal nexthop values are 0.0.0.0, 0.*.*.*, the address of any local interface on this router, and any address in the range 224.*.*.* to 255.*.*.*.
bgp router-id
Sets the BGP router-id. The no form of this command sets the router-id to the default setting, which is the highest IP address on the RCP, or the highest loopback address on the RCP. Syntax bgp router-id ip-address
5-36
bgp-topology-neighbor
To add a BGP neighbor into the RCP managed topology, use the bgp-topology-neighbor command in topology-map configuration mode. Multiple BGP neighbor can be specified in topology map. Syntax bgp-topology-neighbor <ip-address> [md5 password [<encryption-type>] <password>] [asnum <as-number>] no bgp-topology-neighbor <ip-address> [md5 password [<encryption-type>] <password>] [as-num <as-number>] Parameters Parameter ip-address md5 <password> encrypted Description IP address of BGP neighbor [Optional] Use MD5 algorithm. Password. [Optional] Whether the password will be encrypted for display. Autonomous System ID Integer None String None Type/Range String Default None
as-number Mode
bmosp
The SVA calculates MOS values for RTP streams that are detected at an SVA monitoring point
5-37
5-38
bsmos
Bad Speech MOS percentage threshold value. Bad Video MOS percentage threshold value. set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. If the percentage of sessions with a bad MOS ratio is greater than this value an alarm will be sent. If the percentage of sessions with a bad MOS ratio is less than or equal to this value the alarm will be cleared.
0-100
60
bvmos
40-100
60
interval1 interval2
None None
clear
0-99
none
capability opaque
Enables the RCP to allow Opaque LSAs (Types 9, 10, and 11) (default). The no form of this command disables the RCPs capability to handle Opaque LSAs. Syntax capability opaque no capability opaque Mode Router Configuration (OSPF)
5-39
casr
Call Authentication Success Ratio (CASR) is a percentage of call authentication attempts that are successful. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the CASR alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the CASR alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS. The set threshold must be less than or equal to the clear threshold per time interval. Syntax casr {[interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } no casr {[interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter interval1 interval2 interval3 interval4 set clear Description set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. Value of ratio is less than this value, alert will set. Value of ratio is greater than or equal to this value, alert will clear. 00 to 100 where 00 implies off. 00 to 100 Type/Range Default None None None None 00 00
ccsr
Call Connect Success Ratio (CCSR) is the call connection attempt success ratio. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the CCSR alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of threshold values, will disable the CCSR alert for that time interval.
5-40
This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS based on the Call Connection Success Ratio. The set threshold must be less than or equal to the clear threshold per time interval. Syntax ccsr {[interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } no ccsr {[interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter interval1 interval2 interval3 interval4 set clear Description set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. Value of ratio is less than this value, alert will set. Value of ratio is greater than or equal to this value, alert will clear. 00 to 100 where 00 implies off. 00 to 100 Type/Range Default None None None None 00 00
cd
Changes the default file directory. Syntax cd [directory-name] Parameters Parameter Description
5-41
directory-name
Mode Privileged EXEC Guidelines The device argument within a directory-name or filename specification refers to both physicaldevices and logical devices (directory areas). For a complete list of valid device arguments, referto the dir command documentation.
cdd
The Call Disconnect Delay (CDD) threshold is the percentage of call sessions with a CDD that exceeds the std-dly or non-std-dly configured. The delays are specified in milliseconds. The system determines which delay to use based on the destination ID of the session. If the prefix of the destination ID is defined in the non-standard list (see session-non-std-dest command), the non-std-dly is used. Otherwise, the std-dly is used. If the percentage of sessions with excessive CDD is greater than or equal to the defined threshold, the ACDD alert is generated. The command replaces the existing delay values and/or the settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the ACDD alert for all time intervals and returns the delay values to their default. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the ACDD alert for that time interval. The no form of the command with the std-dly or non-std-dly value will return the setting to its default value. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS. The set threshold must be greater than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax cdd {[std-dly std-dly>] [non-std-dly non-std-dly>] [interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } no cdd {[std-dly std-dly>] [non-std-dly non-std-dly>] [interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter Description Type/Range Default
5-42
std-dly
CDD delay in ms for sessions with default destinations; i.e. not a non-standard prefix. CDD delay in ms for sessions with a nonstandard destination; i.e. a non-standard prefix. set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. If the percentage of sessions with an excessive delay is greater than this value an alarm will be sent. If the percentage of sessions with an excessive delay is less than or equal to this value the alarm will be cleared.
0-65535
5000 ms
non-std-dly
0-65535
5000 ms
interval1 interval2
None None
clear
0-99
none
5-43
Parameter access-list-id
Description Alphanumeric name string of the access-list for which the counter is beingreset.
clear arp-cache
Clears all dynamic entries within the Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) table. Syntax clear arp-cache Mode Privileged EXEC
5-44
clear counters
Clears the show interfaces or show controllers counters for the specified interface or port. If aninterface or port is not specified, then all interfaces and ports are cleared. Syntax clear counters [interface-name | port-name] Parameters Parameter interface-name Description {admin 0 | loopback loopback-number | nnet rcp-number | null 0 | portchan channel-number | pos-chan channelnumber | tunnel tunnel-number} Mode Privileged Exec Guidelines If an interface or port is not specified on the input of this command, then all interfaces and portswill be cleared. To confirm that clearing the counters of all interfaces and ports is what the userintended, a warning message is displayed along with a confirmation message. Type y to continueor n to cancel this command.Clearing of the show controllers counters associated with SONET Performance Monitoring isaccomplished through use of the clear pm command.
clear host
Clears associations made between a host name and one or more IP addresses. Syntax clear host {host | *} Parameters Parameter host * Description Name of host device for which the associated IP address(es) will be cleared. Clears the associated IP address(es) for all host names.
5-45
Mode Privileged Exec Guidelines Clearing a static name/address association also removes the corresponding CLI command entryassignment by automatically performing the equivalent of a no ip host command.
clear host-login-lockout
Clear system lockout of login connections from host IP. If no IP address is specified, all locks will be cleared. NOTE: if the system has logged some number of consecutive login failures from a host, the count is cleared even if lockout has not yet occurred. Syntax clear host-login-lockout [ip-address <ip-address>]
Parameters Parameter ip-address Mode User EXEC Description IP address of host to clear existing lockout.
5-46
interface-name
{admin 0 | loopback loopback-number | nnet rcp-number | null 0 | portchan channel-number | pos-chan channelnumber | tunnel tunnel-number}
5-47
clear ip bgp
Clears a BGP connection. Syntax clear ip bgp {* | as-number | peer-ip-address} [vrf vrf-name] [[ipv4 | ipv6] [unicast | multicast]| [vpnv4 | vpnv6] [unicast | multicast] [rd {16-bit-integer:16-bit-integer | ipaddress:16-bitinteger}]][soft] [in [aspath-filter | comm-filter | extcomm-filter | prefix-filter] | out] Parameters Parameter * as-number Description Clears all current BGP peer sessions Clears all BGP connections for peers with this autonomous system number (orsymbol, if created with define as. Clears this specific peers BGP connection specified by either an IPv4 orIPv6 address. Alpha-numeric-symbolic name for the VPN Routing and Forwarding (VRF) for which the routes will be cleared for, range is 1 to 40 characters. ipv4 ipv6 unicast multicast vpnv4 Specifies IPv4 address family. Specifies IPv6 address family. Specifies unicast connections. Specifies multicast connections. Specifies VPN version 4 address family.
peer-ip-address vrf-name
5-48
vpnv6 rd 16-bit-integer ip-address soft in aspath-filter comm-filter extcomm-filter prefix-filter out Mode Privileged Exec
Specifies VPN version 6 address family. Specifies route distiguisher. 16-bit integer, range is 0 to 65535. IP address expressed in dotted decimal form (A.B.C.D). Session is cleared without resetting the BGP TCP session (soft re-configuration). Inbound soft re-configuration. Sends updated as-path-filter information to the peer router. Sends updated community-filter information to the peer router. Sends updated extended-community-filter information to the peer router. Sends updated prefix-filter information to the peer router. Outbound soft re-configuration.
5-49
Specifies route distiguisher. 16-bit integer, range is 0 to 65535. IP address expressed in dotted decimal form (A.B.C.D). Subnet mask of the address for which flapstatistics are being cleared. IP address and mask length of the network for which IP flap-statisticsare being cleared. Clears flap-statistics for all the addresses that pass this access list. Clears flap-statistics for all the addresses that match this regularexpression.
5-50
vpnv6 rd 16-bit-integer ip-address soft in aspath-filter comm-filter extcomm-filter prefix-filter out Mode Privileged Exec Guidelines
Specifies VPN version 6 address family. Specifies route distiguisher. 16-bit integer, range is 0 to 65535. IP address expressed in dotted decimal form (A.B.C.D). Session is cleared without resetting the BGP TCP session (soft re-configuration). Inbound soft re-configuration. Sends updated as-path-filter information to the peer router. Sends updated community-filter information to the peer router. Sends updated extended-community-filter information to the peer router. Sends updated prefix-filter information to the peer router. Outbound soft re-configuration.
The BGP peer router should apply the transmitted filter when sending updates.
neighbor
5-51
interface-name
{loopback loopback-number | port-chan channel-number[.subinterface] |pos-chan channel-number | tunnel tunnel-number} Clears counters for the neighbor with this router ID.
ip-address
Mode Privileged Exec Guidelines This command performs the following functions: Resets all neighbors Deletes all self-originated LSAs Removes all OSPF routes from the RIB Re-establishes neighbor adjacencies Re-originates all self-originated LSAs Re-adds OSPF routes to the RIB This command is similar to deleting and re-adding the OSPF instance except that the configuration for the OSPF instance is preserved.
5-52
clear ip route
Validates that the specified IP route or all IP routes should be in the routing table. Syntax clear ip route {ip-address [netmask] | ip-address/mask-length | *} Parameters Parameter ip-address [netmask] ip-address/mask-length * Mode Privileged Exec Description IP address and subnet mask of the IP route to be validated. IP address and netmask length of the route to be validated. Validates all IP routes.
clear ip static-routes
Removes all IP static routes from the routing table. Syntax clear ip static-routes Mode Privileged Exec Guidelines Use with caution. This command permanently deletes all IP static routes from the routing tableand the running-configuration.
clear vlan
Clears the show vlan counters for the specified VLAN identifier, or optionally, for all VLAN identifiers. Syntax clear vlan {statistics | vlan-id} Parameters Parameter statistics vlan-id Description Clear counters for all VLAN identifiers. Clear counters for one VLAN identifier, range is 1 to 4094.
cli-access host
To configuration CLI related information so that SVP can communicate with CLI running on the
5-54
access-type {telnet | ssh} privilege-level <level> priv-password <privpassword> prompt <prompt-string> internal <value> Mode Topology map router configuration
clock set
Manually sets the system clock value. Syntax clock set {hh:mm:ss dd month yyyy | hh:mm:ss month dd yyyy}
5-55
clock summer-time
Enables automatic switching to and from daylight savings time. The no form of this commanddisables automatic switching to and from daylight savings time. Syntax clock summer-time zone {date {dd month yyyy hh:mm dd month yyyy hh:mm | month dd yyyyhh:mm month dd yyyy hh:mm} [minutes-offset] | recurring [{week | last} day month hh:mm{week | last} day month hh:mm [minutes-offset]]} no clock summer-time [zone {date {dd month yyyy hh:mm dd month yyyy hh:mm | month ddyyyy hh:mm month dd yyyy hh:mm} [minutes-offset] | recurring [{week | last} day month hh:mm{week | last} day month hh:mm [minutes-offset]]}] Parameters Parameter zone Description Name of time zone when daylight savings time is in effect, range is 1 to 8 alphanumericcharacters.
5-56
Specifies the start time and end time for daylight saving time. Day of the week, range is 1 to 31. Name of the month, only the first three letters of the month are significant. Year, range is 1970 to 2035. Hours and minutes. Number of minutes to offset for daylight savings time, default is 60. Specifies when daylight savings time should begin and end. Week number of the month, range is 1 to 5 (or last). Day of the week, values are Sunday, Monday, Tuesday, Wednesday, Thursday, Friday,Saturday. Name of the month, only the first three letters of the month are significant. Hours and minutes in 24-hour time.
clock timezone
Sets the utilized time zone to a user entered value. The no form of this command sets the utilizedtime zone to Coordinated Universal Time (UTC). Syntax clock timezone zone hours-offset [minutes-offset] no clock timezone [zone hours-offset [minutes-offset]] Parameters Parameter zone Description Name of time zone when standard time is in effect, range is 1 to 8 alphanumericcharacters. Number of hours to offset from UTC.
hours-offset
5-57
commit-based-config
Sets the configuration method for configuration mode to commit-based. The no form of this command sets the method to auto-based (default). Syntax commit-based-config no commit-based-config Mode Global Configuration Guidelines While in the commit-based configuration method, the commit command is used to exit configuration mode to the Privileged EXEC Mode and keep all the changes that were made sinceinitialing entering into configuration mode by typing the config command. If in commit-based configuration method and end is entered from any configuration mode, or exitis entered from Global Configuration Mode, a warning message will be displayed informing thatconfiguration changes will not be saved. Confirmation to continue must be given. A y or CRresponse will leave configuration mode without committing changes; any other response will stayin configuration mode.
commit
Performs an exit of a configuration mode to the Privileged EXEC mode, and keeps all changesmade while in configuration mode. Syntax commit Mode All configuration command modes
compatible rfc1583
Enables the RCP to use the method specified in RFC 1583 for calculating summary route
5-58
configure
Enters Global Configuration Mode. Syntax configure [terminal] Mode Privileged Exec
continue
Enables route-map processing to continue even if the route-map has resulted in a match. If nosequence number is specified, this command goes to the next sequence number in the routemap.The no version of this command removes the continue statement from the route-map. Syntax continue [routemap-sequence-number] no continue [routemap-sequence-number] Parameters Parameter routemap-sequence-number Description Route-map sequence number at which processing shouldcontinue, or the next highest number after this one, if this number is not in the sequence.
5-59
Guidelines In combination with the routemap-exit command, this command allows the user to create something like an if-then-else in a route-map. The continue command provides a forward branchoperation and routemap-exit allows the user to terminate processing at the end of an isolatedsegment of the route-map. For multiple set commands setting the same parameter, the last setcommand is the one that is used.
copsrm router-id
This command specifies the interface IP address to be used as the router ID for COPS-RM. The default router ID is taken from the loop back interface (if configured) or the highest interface IP address on the SVP. The no form of this command returns the router ID to the default. The IP address used must ensure reachability between the SVM and all SVPs participating in the COPS-RM protocol. Syntax copsrm router-id<interface-ip-address> no copsrm router-id<interface-ip-address> Parameters Parameter interface-ipaddress Description Interface IP address to be used for COPS-RM router ID. Type/Range IP address in dotted notation. Default Loopback interface IP or highest interface IP.
copsrm shutdown
This command closes all open COPS-RM peering sessions. The no form of this command allows connection attempts to be made. Syntax copsrm shutdown no copsrm shutdown Mode COPS-RM router configuration
5-60
copy
Copies a file from a source location to a destination location. Syntax copy source destination Parameters Parameter Description
5-61
source
Source location of the file, can be one of the following sources: filename Name of the file as [device:][directory/]file. ftp://[username[:password]@]remotehost/filename Copy the file using FTP. http://rhost/filename Copy the file using HTTP. pftp://[username[:password]@]remotehost/filename Copy the file using passive mode FTP. rcp://[username@]rhost/filename Copy the file using RCP. running-config Copy the file from the current system configuration. scp://[username@]rhost/filename Copy the file using SCP. startup-config Copy the file from the startup configuration. tftp://rhost/filename Copy the file using TFTP. destination Destination of the file, can be one of the following destinations: filename Name of the file as [device:][directory/]file. ftp://[username[:password]@]remotehost/filename Copy the file using FTP. pftp://[username[:password]@]remotehost/filename Copy the file using passive mode FTP. rcp://[username@]rhost/filename Copy the file using RCP. running-config [verbose] Copy the file to the current system configuration. Optionally, if verbose is specified, echo the commands from the running configuration to the screen. scp://[username@]rhost/filename Copy the file using SCP. startup-config Copy the file to the startup configuration. tftp://rhost/filename Copy the file using TFTP.
5-62
Mode Privileged EXEC Guidelines The device argument within a directory-name or filename specification refers to both physicaldevices and logical devices (directory areas). For a complete list of valid device arguments, referto the dir command documentation. When the cdrw device is specified in the destination argument of this command, cd-rw mediamust be utilized (since data cannot be copied to cd-r media). Regardless of type, media shouldalways be removed from the cdrw device by using the eject command. Care should be taken not to enter arguments that are shortened forms of the reserved runningconfigand startup-config filenames, as this command will automatically complete the syntax tobe running-config and startup-config.
dcd
Drop Call Duration (DCD) is an average duration of successfully established call sessions that are terminated with a non-normal disconnect reason. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the DCD alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the DCD alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS. The set threshold must be less than or equal to the clear threshold.
5-63
Syntax dcd {[interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } no dcd {[interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter interval1 interval2 interval3 interval4 set Description set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. Value of duration in seconds is less than this value, alert will set. Value of duration in seconds is greater than or equal to this value, alert will clear. 0 to 300 where 00 implies off. 00 to 300 Type/Range Default None None None None 0
clear
dcr
Drop Call Ratio (DCR) is a percentage of successfully established calls that are disconnected for a non-normal cause. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the DCR alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the DCR alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS. The clear threshold must be less than or equal to the set threshold per time interval. Syntax dcr {[interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set>
5-64
clear
00
debug all
The debug all form of this command is not supported. The no form of this command turns off alldebug commands at one time. Syntax no debug all Mode Privileged EXEC Guidelines The debug all form of this command is not supported because the flood of messages that wouldresult from turning on all debug messages would be problematic.
debug dampening
5-65
Mode Privileged EXEC Guidelines If no parameter or all is specified, debug is enabled on all links, otherwise, it is enabled on a specific link.
debug ip bgp
Turns on debugging for the given BGP peer or all peers if no peer is specified. The no form of thiscommand turns off debugging for the given peer, or, if no peer is specified, turns off debuggingfor all peers. Syntax debug ip bgp [ip-address] no debug ip bgp [ip-address] Parameters Parameter ip-address Description Address of the BGP peer to which the debugging applies, if none is entered, debugging is turned on for all peers, with all options.
Mode
5-66
5-68
5-69
5-70
in out
debug ip copsrm
This command enables various debug options. The no form of this command disables the specified debug option. Syntax debug ip copsrm { events | protocol-errors | keepalives | open | <router-id> packets } no debug ip copsrm { events | protocol-errors | keepalives | open | <router-id> packets } Parameters Parameter events Description Various events are logged. Type/Range Default None
5-71
Detected protocol errors are logged. Reception of keep alive messages are logged. TCP connection events are logged. IP address identifying the router ID of the neighbor. Enables logging of packets exchanged with specified neighbor. IP address in dotted notation
packets
None
Mode EXEC
5-72
5-73
dd
header
5-74
hello
Displays information about each OSPF Hello (discover/maintain neighbors) packet received
lsr
Displays information about each OSPF Link State Request (database download) packet received
lsu
Displays information about each OSPF Link State Update (database update) packet received.
access-list-id
5-75
debug sm
This is grouped command of three different debugging commands to display information from SM module. Syntax debug sm command <command-string>[oid <obj-id>] [parameter <string>] debug sm show-object <obj-name-string>[oid <obj-id>] [parameter <string>] debug sm show-summary [<string>] Parameters Parameter <command-string> <obj-id> <obj-name-string> Mode EXEC SM command string object ID, in 32-bit integer format object name in string format Description
debug topology
Enables the logging of TM-RM, TM-IRPM messages and information for next hop.
5-76
define as
Creates a symbol that can be used on the RCP to represent the as-number specified. The noform of this command deletes the symbol. Syntax define as symbol-name as-number no define as symbol-name [as-number] Parameters Parameter symbol-name Description Alphanumeric text string (that begins with an alphabetic character) of up to 20characters representing the as-number. Autonomous system number for which the symbol is being created.
as-number
define community
Creates a symbol that can be used on the RCP to represent the community number specified.The no form of this command deletes the symbol. Syntax define community symbol-name community-number
5-77
no define community symbol-name [community-number] Parameters Parameter symbol-name Description Alphanumeric text string (that begins with an alphabetic character) of up to 20characters representing the as-number. Community number for which the symbol is being created.
community-number
define dscp
Creates a symbol that can be used on the RCP to represent the IP DSCP number(s) specified.The no form of this command deletes the symbol. Syntax define dscp symbol-name ip-dscp-number no define dscp symbol-name [ip-dscp-number] Parameters Parameter symbol-name Description Alphanumeric text string (that begins with an alphabetic character) of up to 20 characters representing the ip-dscpnumber, the well known DSCP symbolic names are:
5-78
Mode Global Configuration Guidelines It is recommended that groups of up to eight IP DSCP numbers (whose upper three bits are thesame) representing the same class should be entered separated by white-spaces.
define icmp-code
Creates a symbol that can be used on the RCP to represent the ICMP code and, optionally, theICMP subcode specified. The no form of this command deletes the symbol. Syntax define icmp-code symbol-name icmp-code-number [subcode icmp-subcode-number] no define icmp-code symbol-name [icmp-code-number] [subcode icmp-subcode-number]
5-79
icmp-code-number icmp-subcode-number
define icmp-type
Creates a symbol that can be used on the router to represent the ICMP message type specified.The no form of this command deletes the symbol. Syntax define icmp-type symbol-name icmp-type-number no define icmp-type symbol-name [icmp-type-number] Parameters Parameter symbol-name Description Alphanumeric text string (that begins with an alphabetic character) of up to 20characters representing the icmp-typenumber. ICMP message type number for which the symbol is being created, rangeis 0 to 255.
icmp-type-number
define igmp-type
Creates a symbol that can be used on the RCP to represent the IGMP protocol specified. The
5-80
igmp-protocol-number
define ip-precedence
Creates a symbol that can be used on the RCP to represent the IP precedence number(s) specified. The no form of this command deletes the symbol. Syntax define ip-precedence symbol-name ip-precedence-number no define ip-precedence symbol-name [ip-precedence-number] Parameters Parameter symbol-name Description Alphanumeric text string (that begins with an alphabetic character) of up to 20characters representing the ipprecedence-number. Numerical value representing the IP precedence bits for which thesymbol is being created, range is 0 to 7
ip-precedence-number
5-81
define ip-protocol
Creates a symbol that can be used on the RCP to represent the IP protocol specified. The noform of this command deletes the symbol. Syntax define ip-protocol symbol-name ip-protocol-number no define ip-protocol symbol-name [ip-protocol-number] Parameters Parameter symbol-name Description Alphanumeric text string (that begins with an alphabetic character) of up to 20characters representing the ip-protocolnumber. IP protocol number for which the symbol is being created, range is 0 to255.
ip-protocol-number
define ipv6-protocol
Creates a symbol that can be used on the RCP to represent the IPv6 protocol specified. The noform of this command deletes the symbol. Syntax define ipv6-protocol symbol-name ipv6-protocol-number no define ipv6-protocol symbol-name [ipv6-protocol-number] Parameters Parameter symbol-name Description Alphanumeric text string (that begins with an alphabetic character) of up to 20characters representing the ip-protocolnumber. IPv6 protocol number for which the symbol is being created, range is 0to 255.
ipv6-protocol-number
5-82
define mpls-experimental
Creates a symbol that can be used on the RCP to represent the MPLS experimental number(s)specified. The no form of this command deletes the symbol. Syntax define mpls-experimental symbol-name mpls-exp-number no define mpls-experimental symbol-name [mpls-exp-number] Parameters Parameter symbol-name Description Alphanumeric text string (that begins with an alphabetic character) of up to 20characters representing the mpls-expnumber. Numerical value representing the MPLS experimental bits for which thesymbol is being created, range is 0 to 7.
mpls-exp-number
define tcp-port
Creates a symbol that can be used on the RCP to represent the TCP port specified. The no formof this command deletes the symbol. Syntax define tcp-port symbol-name tcp-port no define tcp-port symbol-name [tcp-port] Parameters Parameter symbol-name Description Alphanumeric text string (that begins with an alphabetic character) of up to 20characters representing the tcp-port.
5-83
tcp-port
TCP port for which the symbol is being created, range is 0 to 65535.
define tos-code
Creates a symbol that can be used on the RCP to represent the Type of Service (ToS) code number(s) specified. The no form of this command deletes the symbol. Syntax define tos-code symbol-name ip-tos-number no define tos-code symbol-name [ip-tos-number] Parameters Parameter symbol-name Description Alphanumeric text string (that begins with an alphabetic character) of up to 20characters representing the ip-tosnumber. ToS number for which the symbol is being created, range is 0 to 15.
ip-tos-number
define udp-port
Creates a symbol that can be used on the RCP to represent the UDP port specified. The no formof this command deletes the symbol. define udp-port symbol-name udp-port no define udp-port symbol-name [udp-port] Parameters Parameter Description
5-84
symbol-name
Alphanumeric text string (that begins with an alphabetic character) of up to 20 characters representing the udp-port.
udp-port
UDP port for which the symbol is being created, range is 0 to 65535.
delete
Deletes a file from a file directory. Syntax delete filename Parameters Parameter filename Mode Privileged EXEC Guidelines The device argument within a directory-name or filename specification refers to both physicaldevices and logical devices (directory areas). For a complete list of valid device arguments, referto the dir command documentation.When this command is issued with the startup-config filename, all of the configuration lines inthe startup-config file are deleted except end. Description Name of the file as [device:][directory/]file.
deny (extended)
In an extended access-list, sets the conditions under which packets are denied. The no form ofthis command removes a deny condition from the access-list through specification of a sequencenumber and/or matching deny clause. Syntax deny [seq sequence-number] [rcp] {protocol | ip} {source-ip-address source-wildmask | any |host source-ip-address} {dest-ip-address dest-wildmask | any | host dest-ip-address} *[dscpdscp-value | precedence precedence-value | tos tos-value | {log | log-input} | fragments]
5-85
no deny {seq sequence-number | [seq sequence-number] [rcp] {protocol | ip} {sourceipaddresssourc-wildmask | any | host source-ip-address} {dest-ip-address dest-wildmask | any |host dest-ip-address} *[dscp dscp-value | precedence precedence-value | tos tos-value | {log |log-input} | fragments]} Parameters Parameter sequence-number Description Unique sequence number of the deny clause being added or deleted; by default, sequence numbers start at 10 and increment by 10 for each entry added to the end ofthe access-list. rcp Specifies that this clause should allow an extended set of options only available on theRCP; therefore, this clause will not be applied on the line card. Name or number of an internet protocol, or symbol-name as defined in define ipprotocol,valid protocol numbers are 0 to 255 (RCP option only). Any IP protocol. Access is denied for packets originating from this sourceIP address and wildcard mask combination. Access is denied for packets originating from any source IP addresses. Access is denied for packets originating from this source IP addresshost. Access is denied for packets sent to this destination IPaddress and wildcard mask combination. Access is denied for packets sent to any destination IP address. Access is denied for packets sent to this destination IP address host. DSCP value to be matched, range is 0 to 63, or a well-known DSCP name, orsymbolname if defined in define dscp. Precedence level to be matched, valid entries are 0 to 7, or a well-known precedence name, or symbol-name if defined in define ip-precedence.
protocol
ip source-ip-address source-wildmask
precedence-value
5-86
tos-value
Service level to be matched, range is 0 to 15, or a well-known ToS name (RCPoption only). Specifies that information about matching packets will be sent to the console. Specifies that the input interface is to be included in the log. Specifies that packets in IP datagram fragments are to be matched (RCP option only).
icmp-subcode
5-87
dest-tcp-port
5-88
TCP flag to be matched (RCP option only). TCP flag to be matched (RCP option only) TCP flag to be matched (RCP option only). TCP flag to be matched (RCP option only).
See the deny (extended) command for other descriptions of inputs that are common between theIP access-list family of commands.
5-89
source-udp-port
Decimal number or well-known name of the source UDP port, or symbolnameif defined in define udp-port. Decimal number or well-known name of the source UDP port, or symbolnameif defined in define udp-port.
dest-udp-port
Mode IP Extended Access-List Configuration Guidelines See the deny (extended) command for other descriptions of inputs that are common between theIP access-list family of commands.
deny (IPv6)
Sets the conditions under which packets are denied. The no form of this command removes adeny condition from the access-list through specification of a sequence number and/or matchingdeny clause. Syntax deny [seq sequence-number] {protocol | ipv6} {source-ipv6-address/masklength | any | hostsource-ipv6-address} {dest-ipv6-address/masklength | any | host dest-ipv6-address} *[dscpdscp-value | precedence precedence-value | tos tos-value | {log | log-input} | fragments] no deny {seq sequence-number | [seq sequence-number] {protocol | ipv6} {source-ipv6address/masklength | any | host source-ipv6-address} {dest-ipv6-address/masklength | any |host dest-ipv6-address} *[dscp dscp-value | precedence precedence-value | tos tos-value | {log| log-input} | fragments]} Parameters Parameter sequence-number Description Unique sequence number of the deny clause being added or deleted; bydefault, sequence numbers start at 10 and increment by 10 for each entry added to the end ofthe access-list. Specifies that this clause should allow an extended set of options only available on theRCP; therefore, this clause will not be applied on the line card.
rcp
5-90
protocol
Name or number of an internet protocol, or symbol-name as defined in define ipv6protocol, valid protocol numbers are 0 to 255 (RCP option only). Any IPv6 protocol. Access is denied for packets originating from this sourceIPv6 address and masklength combination. Access is denied for packets originating from any source IPv6 addresses. Access is denied for packets originating from this source IPv6address host. Access is denied for packets sent to this destination IPv6 address and masklength combination.
ipv6 source-ipv6-address/masklength
Access is denied for packets sent to any destination IPv6 address. Access is denied for packets sent to this destination IPv6 addresshost. DSCP value to be matched, range is 0 to 63, or a well-known DSCP name, orsymbolname if defined in define dscp. Precedence level to be matched, valid entries are 0 to 7, or a well-known precedence name, or symbol-name if defined in define ipv6 precedence.
precedence-value
tos-value
Service level to be matched, range is 0 to 15, or a well-known ToS name (RCPoption only). Specifies that information about matching packets will be sent to the console. Specifies that the input interface is to be included in the log. Specifies that packets in IPv6 datagram fragments are to be matched (RCP option only).
5-91
deny (standard)
In a standard access-list, sets the conditions under which packets are denied. The no form ofthis command removes a deny condition from the access-list through specification of a sequencenumber and/or matching deny clause. Syntax deny [seq sequence-number] {ip-address [wildmask] | any | host ip-address} [log] no deny {seq sequence-number | [seq sequence-number] {ip-address [wildmask] | any | hostip-address} [log]} Parameters Parameter sequence-number Description Unique sequence number of the deny clause being added or deleted; bydefault, sequence numbers start at 10 andincrement by 10 for each entry added to the end ofthe access-list. Access is denied for all addresses matching the IP address andwildcard mask combination (if wildcard mask is not specified, 0.0.0.0 is assumed). Access is denied for all IP addresses. Access is denied for this host IP address. Specifies that information about matching packets will be sent to the console.
ip-address [wildmask]
description (interface)
Assigns a descriptive string to an interface. The no form of this command un-assigns the descriptive string from an interface. Syntax description string no description [string] Parameters
5-92
Parameter string
Description Alpha-numeric-symbolic characters of the description, maximum number of characters is 255. If the string contains a spacecharacter or is null, the string must begin and end with aquotation-mark character ().
diff
Compares two files and displays the differences. Syntax diff filename1 filename2 Parameters Parameter filename1 filename2 Description Name of the first file as[device:][directory/]file. Name of the second file as [device:][directory/]file
Mode Privileged EXEC Guidelines The device argument within a directory-name or filename specification refers to both physicaldevices and logical devices (directory areas). For a complete list of valid device arguments, referto the dir command documentation.
dir
Displays information on all files in a file directory, or a single file in a file directory if a filename isspecified. If no inputs are specified, information on all files in the current file directory is displayed. Syntax
5-93
disable (EXEC)
Exits the Privileged EXEC Mode and/or enters into a lower privileged level. If the level is not specified, the default level is 1 (User EXEC Mode). Syntax disable [level] Parameters Parameter level Mode User EXEC Description Privilege level, range is 0 to 15.
distance (BGP)
5-94
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF)
5-95
distance (OSPF)
Sets the default administrative distance for OSPF routes or the routes specified. The no form ofthis command removes the previously-set default administrative distance and causes the routerto use the default distance of 110 for OSPF routes. Syntax distance default-distance-value [ip-address wildmask [access-list-id]] no distance [default-distance-value] [ip-address wildmask [access-list-id]] Parameters Parameter default-distance-value ip-address wildmask Description Default administrative distance for OSPF routes, range is 1 to 255. Sets the administrative distance for routes matching this IP address andinverse mask (wildmask). Sets the administrative distance for routes permitted by this standard IP accesslist.
access-list-id
distance bgp
Specifies administrative distances to be used for external, internal, and local BGP routes. The noform of this command returns the distance values to their defaults. Syntax distance bgp distance-external distance-internal distance-local no distance bgp [distance-external distance-internal distance-local] Parameters Parameter Description
5-96
distance-external
Administrative distance to be used for BGP external routes, range is 1 to255, default is 20. Administrative distance to be used for BGP internal routes, range is 1 to255, default is 200. Administrative distance to be used for BGP local routes, range is 1 to 255,default is 200.
distance-internal
distance-local
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF)
distance ospf
Defines OSPF route administrative distances by route-type. The no form of this command setsthe distance to the default of 110. Syntax distance ospf [external distance-value] [inter-area distance-value] [intra-area distance-value] no distance ospf [external distance-value] [inter-area distance-value] [intra-area distancevalue] Parameters Parameter external distance-value Description Administrative distance for external routes (learned throughredistribution into OSPF), range is 0 to 255. Administrative distance for OSPF routes within this area, range is 0to 255. Administrative distance for OSPF routes between areas, range is 0to 255.
distribute-list in (BGP)
5-97
dsr
Data Success Ratio (DSR) is an aggregate percentage of data session attempts that are successful. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the DSR alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the DSR alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS based on the Data Success Ratio. The set threshold must be less than or equal to the clear threshold per time interval. Syntax dsr {[interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } no dsr {[interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter Description Type/Range Default
5-98
set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. Value of ratio is less than this value, alert will set. Value of ratio is greater than or equal to this value, alert will clear. 00 to 100 where 00 implies off. 00 to 100
echo-analysis
This command is used to customize the echo analysis performed by the SVA when it is enabled to perform analogue analysis. Echo detection is performed from the perspective of the calling and the called party if streams in both directions have approximately the same energy level. When one direction has a significantly lower energy level than the other direction, echo analysis cannot be performed accurately for that direction. The allowed-signal-level-difference parameter defines the boundary for this determination. Echo analysis is performed by identifying periods of active speech and then searching for echo in the opposite direction during these active speech periods. Active speech is identified by first calculating the active signal level throughout the call sample as specified by the media-analysis command. The signal level is then calculated for subintervals of the call sample. Subintervals whose signal level is close to the sample's signal level is treated as active speech. The talkeractive-level parameter defines the range for this comparison. If the Signal to Noise Ratio (SNR) of the talker's stream is small, it may not be possible to distinguish active speech from noise. The talker-minimum-snr parameter specifies the criterion for making this determination. The duration of the active speech period must be long enough to perform the echo detection algorithm. The talker-minimum-active-duration parameter defines the minimum amount of active speech required. To accommodate breaks in speech, periods of active speech with intermediate pauses can be viewed as a continues talking period if the ratio of speech to silence is sufficiently high. The talker-active-ratio parameter determines the acceptable percentage. Since echo is detected at a mathematical model, the analysis may indicate echo when it is not perceptible to the human ear. The echo result is expressed as an Echo Return Loss (ERL) and delay from the original source signal. By default the system filters echo results based on the standard G.131 specification, in addition a tighter limit is applied to decrease the likelihood that
5-99
5-100
allowed-signal-leveldifference
The allowed signal level difference between the direction with the highest signal level and the other's direction signal level. If the difference is greater than this value, echo analysis will only performed for the direction with the highest signal level. If the sub second interval's signal level is smaller than the call's signal level for the talker, and the difference is greater than this value, the interval is not considered to contain active speech. The minimum SNR value required for the talker's direction to enable echo analysis to be performed. The minimum active duration the talker must speak before analysis is performed. The ratio of active speech to silence that must be maintained while determining the active speech duration. The minimum percentage of time echo must be detected during an interval to be reported. If the provisioned ratio is not met, the echo is classified as no echo. If the echo ERL measured is greater than this value and the echo delay is greater than the delay parameter, the echo should be considered acceptable. See erl parameter above for a description. If the measured signal level during the echo period is less than this value, unacceptable echo will be labeled as acceptable.
0 to 100 dB
4 dB
talker-active-level
-10 dBov
talker-minimum-snr
20 to 60 dB
26 dB
talker-minimum-activeduration talker-active-ratio
5 seconds 80
echo-occurrence-ratio
0 to 100
80
erl
0 to 100 dB 0 disables this check. 0 to 1000 ms 0 to -100 dBov 0 disables this check.
40
delay echo-level-limit
96 -65 dBov
5-101
listener-active-level
If the sub second interval's signal level is smaller than the call's signal level for the listener, and the difference is less than this value, the interval is considered to contain active speech. This interval will not be analyzed for echo to avoid the affects of double talk. The minimum SNR value required for the listener's direction to enable echo analysis to be performed.
-10
listener-minimum-snr
26 dB
eject
Ejects the compact disk from the compact disk drive. Syntax eject cdrw Mode Privileged EXEC
enable (EXEC)
Exits the User EXEC Mode and/or enters into a higher privileged level. If the level is not specified, the default level is 15 (Privileged EXEC Mode). Syntax enable [level] Parameters Parameter level Mode User EXEC Description Privilege level, range is 0 to 15.
5-102
enable password
Sets a password to control enable access to a specified privilege level. The no form of this command removes a password from a specified privilege level. Syntax enable password [level level] [encryption-type] password no enable password [level level] [[encryption-type] password] Parameters Parameter level Description Privilege level for which access is controlled by password, range is 1 to 15, 1 usually indicates the EXEC mode and 15 (default) usually indicates the Privileged EXEC Mode. Specifies whether the password that follows is encrypted. A value of 0 (default) indicates the following password is not encrypted, and a value of 7 indicates the following password is encrypted. Alpha-numeric-symbolic characters of the password, range is 1 to 25 characters, embedded spaces and quotation marks are not allowed.
encryption-type
password
5-103
enable service
Enables a specified service application. The no form of this command disables a specified service application. Syntax enable service { {{ftp | telnet} [ipv4 | ipv6] [max-connections max-connections]} | ssh [version *{1 | 2}] } no enable service { {{ftp | telnet} [ipv4 | ipv6] [max-connections max-connections]} | ssh [version *{1 | 2}] }
Parameters Parameter ftp telnet ipv4 ipv6 max-connections ssh version 1 version 2 Mode Global Configuration Description Enable or disable (default) the ftp service Enable (default) or disable the telnet service Enables only IPv4 version of the specified service Enables only IPv6 version of the specified service Maximum connections per IP per minute Enable (default) or disable the secure shell service Version 1 of the SSH protocol Version 2 of the SSH protocol (default)
5-104
end
Performs an exit of configuration mode to the Privileged EXEC Mode. Syntax end Mode All configuration command modes
error
NetSocket, Inc. - Proprietary and Confidential 5-105
exec-banner
Enables both the EXEC and message-of-the-day (MOTD) banners (default). The no form of this command disables both the banners. Syntax exec-banner no exec-banner Mode Line Configuration Guidelines The no exec-banner command disables the message-of-the-day (MOTD) banner regardless of the whether the motd-banner command has enabled it.
exec-timeout
Sets the EXEC command line interpreter timeout period. The no form of this command (or specifying 0 minutes and 0 seconds) disables the EXEC command line interpreter timeout function (default). Syntax exec-timeout minutes [seconds] no exec-timeout [minutes [seconds]] Parameters Parameter Description
5-106
minutes seconds
Number of minutes, range is 0 to 65535. Additional number of seconds, range is 0 to 65535, default is 0.
execute
Executes a program group. Syntax execute program-group Parameters Parameter program-group Mode Protmon Configuration Description Name of program group.
exit-address-family
Performs an exit of the Address Family Configuration Mode and returns to the Router Configuration Mode. Syntax exit-address-family Mode Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast)
exit (config)
Performs an exit of a configuration mode and returns to the next highest hierarchal mode. Syntax exit
5-107
exit (EXEC)
Exits the EXEC mode and logs off the RCP. Syntax exit Mode User EXEC
5-108
minutes
Specifies length time in minutes when exporting of information times out, range is 1 to 3600 minutes, default is 30.
Mode Flow Aggregation Cache Configuration Guidelines Version 9 Cflow records exported by a router have an associated template that is sent to the flow collector.
file-count
Sets the number of previous file versions to maintain for the trace file. The no form of this command sets the previous number of file versions to maintain to the default value. Syntax file-count files no file-count [files] Parameters Parameter files Description Number of previous file versions maintained, range is 2 to 10, default is 2.
file-size
Sets the maximum file size for a version of the trace file. The no form of this command sets the maximum file size to the default value. Syntax file-size bytes no file-size [bytes] Parameters
5-109
Parameter bytes
find-as
Evaluates the specified source and destination IP addresses against the Routing Information Base (RIB) and determines, without actually routing the packet, the AS number from which a packet with these IP addresses would have come and the AS number to which the packet would be routed. Syntax find-as source-ip-address destination-ip-address Parameters Parameter source-ip-address destination-ip-address Description Source ip address as it would appear in an IP packet entering this router. Destination ip address as it would appear in an IP packet entering this router.
Mode Privileged EXEC Guidelines If an address is resolved by an IGP route or an IBGP route, the AS number returned will be 0, indicating that the packet is either going to or coming from the AS to which this router belongs.
find-interface
Evaluates the specified source and destination IP addresses against the Routing Information Base (RIB) and determines the expected interface for ingress and egress for these addresses. Syntax find-interface source-ip-address destination-ip-address Parameters
5-110
Description Source ip address as it would appear in an IP packet entering this router. Destination ip address as it would appear in an IP packet entering this router.
find-prefix
Evaluates the specified source and destination IP addresses against the Routing Information Base (RIB) and determines the prefixes from the RIB that would resolve these IP addresses Syntax find-prefix source-ip-address destination-ip-address Parameters Parameter source-ip-address destination-ip-address Description Source ip address as it would appear in an IP packet entering this router. Destination ip address as it would appear in an IP packet entering this router.
Mode Privileged EXEC Guidelines If the prefix cannot be resolved, a route of 0.0.0.0/0 is returned.
fmosp
The calculation of the session's MOS percentage and the method for session categorization is described in the bmosp command. This command specifies the threshold for determining if the session has a Fair MOS percentage. This command also specifies the ratio of all fair sessions to all sessions with MOS scores calculated. If the calculated ratio is greater than the configured threshold, an alert will be generated. The command replaces the existing FMOS threshold and/or the settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the FMOSP alert for all time intervals and returns the FMOS thresholds to their default value. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the FMOSP alert for that time interval. The no form of the command with the FSMOS and/or FVMOS value will return the threshold to its default value.
5-111
This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS. The set threshold must be greater than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax fmosp {[fsmos <fsmos>] [fvmos <fvmos>] [interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } no fmosp {[fsmos <fsmos>] [fvmos <fvmos>] [interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter fsmos Description Fair Speech MOS percentage threshold value. Fair Video MOS percentage threshold value. set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. If the percentage of sessions with a fair MOS ratio is greater than this value an alarm will be sent. If the percentage of sessions with a fair MOS ratio is less than or equal to this value the alarm will be cleared. 0-99 Type/Range 0-100 80 Default
fvmos
40-100
80
interval1 interval2
None None
clear
0-99
none
5-112
format
Formats a blank compact disk. Syntax format cdrw Mode Privileged EXEC Guidelines Because this command destroys all data on a compact disk, this command will display a warning message along with a confirmation message. Type y to continue or n to cancel this command.
ganc
The GANC is a network element used in a UMA or Femtocell deployment that acts as a gateway to the Core Network. The SVP can provide additional information by identifying session flows and data session bandwidth associated with a GANC. The no form of this command removes the GANC configuration for the GANC identified by the site-id. This command puts CLI in ganc configuration mode which enables polling and session path identification configuration commands to be entered. NOTE: If the no form of the command is given and there are active sessions identified with that GANC, the ganc is not removed from the system. Instead a periodic check is made waiting for the sessions to be removed. If the session is a monitor-path session, it must be removed manually using the no monitor path command. Syntax ganc <site-id> no ganc <site-id> Parameters Parameter site-id Description A network unique string for the GANC. Type/Range String Default None
Mode
5-113
gmosp
The calculation of the session's MOS percentage and the method for session categorization is described in the bmosp command. This command specifies the ratio of all good sessions to all sessions with MOS scores calculated. If the calculated ratio is less than the provisioned ratio, an alert will be generated. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the GMOSP alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the GMOSP alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS. The set threshold must be greater than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax gmosp { [interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } no gmosp {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter interval1 interval2 Description set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. If the percentage of sessions with a good MOS ratio is less than this value an alarm will be sent. If the percentage of sessions with a good MOS ratio is greater than or equal to this value the alarm will be cleared. 0-100 Type/Range Default None None
clear
0-100
none
Mode
5-114
help
Displays a brief overview of the help feature. Syntax help Mode All command modes
hisr
Handover In Success Ratio (HISR) is a percentage of handover in attempts that are successful. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the HISR alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the HISR alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS based on the Handover In Success Ratio. The set threshold must be less than or equal to the clear threshold per time interval. Syntax hisr {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } no hisr {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter interval1 interval2 interval3 interval4 Description set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. Type/Range Default None None None None
5-115
set clear
Value of ratio is less than this value, alert will set. Value of ratio is greater than or equal to this value, alert will clear.
00 00
history
Enables the command line history feature (default). Alternatively, with the size keyword specified, this command sets the number of lines in the history buffer. The no history form of this command disables the command line history feature. The no history size form of this command sets the number of lines in the history buffer to the default value. Syntax history [size buffer-size] no history [size [buffer-size]] Parameters Parameter buffer-size Description Number of lines in the history buffer, range is 0 to 255, default is 10.
hosr
Handover Out Success Ratio (HOSR) is a percentage of handover out attempts that are successful. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the HOSR alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the HOSR alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS based on the Handover Out Success Ratio. The set threshold must be less than or equal to the clear threshold per time interval. Syntax hosr {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set
5-116
hostname
Sets a new value for the SVP hostname. The no form of this command sets the hostname back to the default hostname value. This command will be denied if the hostname argument entered matches a hostname already set within another partition, or if the hostname argument entered is one of the reserved default hostname values. Syntax hostname hostname no hostname [hostname] Parameters Parameter hostname Description Network unique name to be assigned to the SVP, range is 1 to 63 alphanumeric or hyphen characters (the first or last character cannot be a hyphen).
5-117
hsrp-mib
This command enables the SVP to gather information from the router's HSRP MIB. HSRP is a Cisco proprietary variation of VRRP. HSRP is deployed at the access point to a network to provide redundancy to hosts connected via a layer 2 network. By enabling this feature for the routers involved in the HSRP scheme, the SVP can accurately determine which router is receiving traffic from the hosts and performing the IP forwarding on behalf of the access network. NOTE: This feature relies on snmp polling being configured for the router in question. If it is not enabled, HSRP collection will not be performed. If the no form of this command is issued, the system will not collect HSRP information from the router. Syntax hsrp-mib [poll-multiple <poll-multiple>] no hsrp-mib [poll-multiple <poll-multiple>] Parameters Parameter poll-multiple Description Number of SNMP poll intervals between hsrp-mib polls. E.g. if snmp-access poll interval is 90 seconds and this value is 2, the hsrp-mib will be polled every 180 seconds. Poll interval should be less than 5 minutes. Type/Range 1-10 1 Default
ignore-media-session
In the beginning of a phone call, a caller may be directed to a voice recorder or may be temporarily connected to a default end point until the true end point is determined. To reflect the true user experience, the SVA must ignore this movement of the end points until the call is properly connected. This command allows the user to configure how these temporary media sessions are identified. The minimum-duration parameter defines the minimum time in seconds a media session must
5-118
Parameters Parameter minimum-duration Description Minimum duration required for a media session to be used for scoring. Stabilized-duration defines the minimum duration expected of a media session when the call end point shuffling is over. Range 0-30 Default 2
stabilized-duration
0, 30-120 0:disabled
install
Installs a new software package on the system. The no form of this command uninstalls a software package on the system.. Syntax install package-name [subpackage-name] [partition {admin | all | hostname | partitionnumber}] {active | peer | self | standby} no install package-name [subpackage-name] [partition {admin | all | hostname | partitionnumber}] {active | peer | self | standby} Parameters Parameter Description
5-119
Name of the software package to be installed. Name of the subpackage within the software package to be installed. Install partition-specific software only within specified partitions. Hostname of a router partition, range is 1 to 63 alphanumeric or hyphen characters (the first or last character cannot be a hyphen).
Router partition number, range is 0 to 5. Installs software on the active RCP. Installs software on peer RCP. Installs software on self RCP. Installs software on the standby RCP.
interface
Enables debug messages of specified interface names (or all names if none specified) to be placed in the trace file. The no form of this command disables debug messages of specified interface names (or all names if none specified) from being placed in the trace file (default). Syntax interface [interface-name]... no interface [interface-name]... Parameters Parameter interface-name Description {admin 0 | loopback loopback-number | null 0 | port-chan channelnumber[. subinterface] | pos-chan channel-number | tunnel tunnelnumber}.
5-120
interface admin
Enters into the Interface Configuration Mode to configure a specified Admin interface. Syntax interface admin 0 Mode Global Configuration
interface loopback
Creates a Loopback interface and enters into the Interface Configuration Mode. The no form of this command deletes a Loopback interface. Syntax interface loopback loopback-number no interface loopback loopback-number Mode Global Configuration Guidelines Loopback 0 is required for proper system operation, and therefore cannot be deleted.
interface nnet
Enters into the Interface Configuration Mode to configure a specified NNET interface. Syntax interface nnet rcp-number Mode Global Configuration
interface null
Enters into the Interface Configuration Mode to configure a specified Null interface.
5-121
interface tunnel
Enters into the Interface Configuration Mode to configure a specified tunnel interface. Currently only GRE interfaces are supported for transport of IP. Syntax interface tunnel number Mode Global Configuration
internal
Enables software-internal debug messages to be placed in the trace file. The no form of this command disables software-internal debug messages from being placed in the trace file (default). Syntax internal no internal Mode Traceoptions Configuration
interval-start-time
Session thresholds can be set for different times of the day so that the sensitivity to network issues can account for peak usage times. This command specifies the start-time for up to 4 times of the day. This model allows for morning peak usage, mid-day usage, afternoon usage and late night usage periods. The end-time of a period is the start-time of the next period. If the time interval is not defined for the session alerts, then no alerts will be generated regardless of whether the alert threshold for that interval is defined. The command specifies the complete set of intervals to be used and replaces any previous setting. The no form of the command will delete all time intervals regardless of what intervals are specified, thus disabling session alert generation.
5-122
This command defines the start hour for the different times of day that that session thresholds will follow. The time interval must be defined in order for the configured set/clear thresholds to take effect. The time intervals are validated to ensure there are no overlaps among the periods. Syntax interval-start-time {[time1 <hh>] | [time1 <hh time2 <hh>] | [time1 <hh time2 <hh> time3 <hh>] | [time1 <hh time2 <hh> time3 <hh> time4 <hh>]} no interval-start-time [[time1 <hh>] | [time1 <hh time2 <hh>] | [time1 <hh time2 <hh> time3 <hh>] | [time1 <hh time2 <hh> time3 <hh> time4 <hh]] Parameters Parameter time1 time2 time3 time4 Description Hour of the day for first time interval. Hour of the day for second time interval. Hour of the day for third time interval. Hour of the day for fourth time interval. Type/Range Decimal 00 to 23 Decimal 00 to 23. Decimal 00 to 23. Decimal 00 to 23. Default None None None None
ip-address
Enables debug messages of prefix or IP address information, based on specified access-lists, to be placed in the trace file. The no form of this command disables debug messages of prefix or IP address information, based on specified access-lists (or all access-lists if none specified), from being placed in the trace file (default). Syntax ip-address {access-list-id}... no ip-address [access-list-id]... Parameters Parameter Description
5-123
access-list-id
Mode Traceoptions Configuration Guidelines The ip-address and ip-address prefix-list commands are mutually exclusive; they cannot be selected as trace options for the same trace file.
ip-address prefix-list
Enables debug messages of prefix or IP address information, based on specified prefix-lists, to be placed in the trace file. The no form of this command disables debug messages of prefix or IP address information, based on specified prefix-lists (or all prefix-lists if none specified), from being placed in the trace file (default). Syntax ip-address prefix-list {prefix-list-id}... no ip-address prefix-list [prefix-list-id]... Parameters Parameter prefix-list-id Description Alphanumeric name string identifier of an prefix-list.
Mode Traceoptions Configuration Guidelines The ip-address and ip-address prefix-list commands are mutually exclusive; they cannot be selected as trace options for the same trace file.
ip access-group (global)
Enables the SVP to conditionally process packets on all interfaces that have inheriting of a global access-list enabled and do not have a per-interface access-list specified, based on a specified global access-list. The no ip access-group form of this command removes the specification of a global access-list. When an rcp-receive access-list is being applied by the SVP (through the ip receive access-list
5-124
ip access-group (interface)
Enables the SVP to conditionally process packets on an interface based on a specified perinterface access-list, or based on an inherited global access-list when a per-interface access-list is not specified (default). The no ip access-group form of this command removes the specification of a per-interface access-list (allowing inheriting of a global access-list, if enabled). The no ip access-group inherit-acl form of this command disables inheriting of a global accesslist. The special string inherit-acl is a keyword of this command and should not be used as the name of an access list identifier. When an rcp-receive access-list is being applied by the SVP (using the ip receive accesslist command) and a per-interface in access-list is also being applied by the SVP (using the interface ip access-group command), the per-interface accesslist is processed first. If a permit or deny match is not found within the per-interface access-list, the rcp-receive access-list is then searched. If a permit or deny match is not found within the rcp-receive access-list, an implicit deny is performed. Syntax ip access-group {access-list-id {in | out} | inherit-acl} no ip access-group {[access-list-id] {in | out} | inherit-acl}
5-125
Mode Interface Configuration (Admin, Loopback, NNET, Null, Tunnel, EM) Subinterface Configuration (EM)
ip access-list
Creates a standard or extended access-list and enters into an Access-List Configuration Mode. The no form of this command deletes an access-list, or removes a clause from the access-list through specification of a sequence number. Syntax ip access-list {standard | extended} access-list-id no ip access-list {standard | extended} access-list-id [seq sequence-number] Parameters Parameter standard extended access-list-id sequence-number Description Standard access-list, the deny and permit commands used must be standard. Extended access-list, the deny and permit commands used may be extended. Alphanumeric name string (40 characters maximum) of the access-list being defined. Sequence number of the clause being removed from the access-list.
5-126
ip access-list sequence-enable
Enables the display of sequence numbers when showing access-lists. The no form of this command disables the display of sequence numbers when showing access-lists (default). Syntax ip access-list sequence-enable no ip access-list sequence-enable Mode Global Configuration
ip address
Assigns an IP address to an interface. The no form of this command un-assigns an IP address to an interface. There is no limit (except router memory) to the number of secondary IP addresses that can be assigned to an interface; however, only one primary IP address can be assigned. Syntax ip address {ip-address netmask | ip-address/mask-length} [secondary] no ip address [{ip-address netmask | ip-address/mask-length} [secondary]] Parameters Parameter ip-address netmask ip-address/mask-length secondary username <username> password <password> Mode Interface Configuration (admin, em, loopback, nnet, tunnel, xyxs) Subinterface Configuration (em) Description IP address and network mask of the interface IP address and mask length of the interface Indicates an assignment of a secondary IP address to the interface. Name of the user for user name password authentication. Password for the user.
ip as-path access-list
Creates or modifies an as-path access list to be used by BGP. The no form of this command
5-127
sequence-number
5-128
ip bgp-community new-format
Displays BGP communities in the format AA:NN (AS-Number:Community Number, each consisting of 2 bytes) (default). The no form of this command sets the BGP community format to NN:AA (Community Number:AS-Number). Syntax ip bgp-community new-format no ip bgp-community new-format Mode Global Configuration
ip broadcast-address
Sets the broadcast address for an interface. The no form of this command sets the broadcast address to the default value. Syntax ip broadcast-address ip-address no ip broadcast-address [ip-address] Parameters Parameter ip-address Description Broadcast IP address of the interface, values are 0.0.0.0 or 255.255.255.255, default is 255.255.255.255
5-129
ip classless
Enables classless interdomain routing (default). Syntax ip classless Mode Global Configuration
ip community-list
Creates or modifies a BGP community list and controls access to that list. The no form of this command deletes the community-list (if no sequence number is specified) or the community-list clause specified by the sequence number. Syntax ip community-list [standard | expanded] community-list-id [seq sequence-number] {permit | deny} {{internet | no-export | local-as | no-advertise} | {community-number}...} no ip community-list community-list-id [seq sequence-number] [{permit | deny} {{internet | no-export | local-as | no-advertise} | {community-number}...}] Parameters Parameter standard expanded Description Standard community list, which can be named by a string. Expanded community list, which can contain regular expressions (default if neither standard nor expanded is entered). Alphanumeric string identifying the community-list.
community-list-id
5-130
sequence-number
Unique sequence number of the deny, permit, or remark clause being added to (or deleted from) the community list; by default, sequence numbers start at 10 and increment by 10 for each entry added to the end of the community list. Permits access for matching communities. Denies access for matching communities. Internet community. Routes with this community are sent to peers in other sub-autonomous systems within a confederation Do not advertise this route to an EBGP peer External systems are those outside the confederation If there is no confederation, an external system is any EBGP peer. Send this route to peers in other subautonomous systems within the local confederation; do not advertise this route to an external system. Do not advertise this route to any peer (internal or external). Community number configured by a set community command; this can be any of the following: number from 1 to 4294967295; specify a single number or multiple numbers separated by a space. number in the format n:m, where n and m are integers in the range 0-65535. community symbol as defined with the define community command; specify a single symbol or multiple symbols separated by a space.
local-as
no-advertise community-number
ip community-list display-community-symbols
Enables the RCP to show community symbols (as configured in the define community command), rather than community numbers, when showing community-lists (default). The no form of this command enables the RCP to display community numbers, not the symbols, when showing community-lists.
5-131
ip community-list sequence-enable
Enables the display of sequence numbers when showing community-lists. The no form of this command disables the display of sequence numbers when showing community-lists (default). Syntax ip community-list sequence-enable no ip community-list sequence-enable
ip default-network
Sets which route will be used as the default network for unknown addresses. The no form of this command removes the default network. Syntax ip default-network ip-address no ip default-network ip-address Parameters Parameter ip-address Mode Global Configuration Description Any valid class A, B, or C IP address.
5-132
ip domain-list
Sets one or more domain names to be appended to the domain search list. The no form of this command removes one or more domain names from the domain search list. Syntax ip domain-list {domain}... no ip domain-list [domain]... Parameters Parameter domain Description Domain name to be appended or removed from the domain search list, up to five alpha-numeric-symbolic domain name entries are allowed separated by spaces. The total number of characters in all entries combined cannot exceed 200.
Mode Global Configuration Guidelines This command appends domain name entries to an internal list. This command is denied if the internal list would exceed a maximum of 5 entries, or if the total number of domain name characters in all entries would exceed 200.
ip domain-lookup
Enables Domain Name System (DNS) lookup for name/address translation (default). The no form of this command disables DNS lookup. Syntax ip domain-lookup no ip domain-lookup Mode Global Configuration
ip domain-name
5-133
Mode Global Configuration Guidelines The default domain name specified by this command will be ignored if one or more default domain names exist within the domain list.
ip extcommunity-list
Creates or modifies a BGP extended community list and controls access to that list. The no form of this command deletes the extended community-list (if no sequence number is specified) or the extended community-list clause specified by the sequence number. Syntax ip extcommunity-list [standard] ext-community-list-id [seq sequence-number] {permit | deny} *{rt {as-number:32-bit-value | ip-address:16-bit-value} | soo {as-number:32-bit-value | ipaddress: 16-bit-value} | lbw {as-number:32-bit-value | ip-address:16-bit-value} | opaque 32-bit integer:32-bit-integer} no ip extcommunity-list [standard] ext-community-list-id [seq sequence-number] {permit | deny} *{rt {as-number:32-bit-value | ip-address:16-bit-value} | soo {as-number:32-bit-value | ipaddress: 16-bit-value} | lbw {as-number:32-bit-value | ip-address:16-bit-value} | opaque 32-bit integer:32-bit-integer} Parameters Parameter standard Description Standard extended community list, which can be named by a string, and cannot contain regular expressions.
5-134
ext-community-list-id sequence-number
Alphanumeric string identifying the extended community-list. Unique sequence number of the deny, permit, or remark clause being added to (or deleted from) the extended community list; by default, sequence numbers start at 10 and increment by 10 for each entry added to the end of the extended community list. Permits access for matching extended communities. Denies access for matching extended communities. Matches routes with this Route Target (rt) extended community attribute value. Matches routes with this Route Target (rt) extended community attribute value. Matches routes with this soo (site-of-origin) extended community attribute value. Matches routes with this Link Bandwidth (lbw) extended community attribute value. Matches routes with this Link Bandwidth (lbw) extended community attribute value. Matches routes with this extended community type and value (a raw 64-bit extended community value).
permit deny rt as-number:32-bit-value rt ip-address:16-bit-value soo as-number:32-bit-value lbw as-number:32-bit-value lbw ip-address:16-bit-value opaque 32-bit integer:32-bit-integer
ip extcommunity-list sequence-enable
Enables the display of sequence numbers when showing extended community-lists. The no form of this command disables the display of sequence numbers when showing extended communitylists (default). Syntax ip extcommunity-list sequence-enable no ip extcommunity-list sequence-enable Mode Global Configuration
5-135
ip forwarding
By default packets received are not forwarded. Forwarding should only be enabled in rare instances such as when NAT is enabled. Syntax ip forwarding no ip forwarding Mode Global Configuration
ip ftp password
Sets a File Transfer Protocol (FTP) password. The no form of this command removes an FTP password. Syntax ip ftp password [encryption-type] password no ip ftp password [[encryption-type] password] Parameters Parameter encryption-type Description Specifies whether the password that follows is encrypted, a value of 0 (default) indicates the following password is not encrypted, and a value of 7 indicates the following password is encrypted. Alpha-numeric-symbolic characters of the password, range is 1 to 25 characters, embedded spaces and quotation marks are not allowed.
password
ip ftp source-interface
Sets the File Transfer Protocol (FTP) connection source address to that of the specified
5-136
ip ftp username
Sets a File Transfer Protocol (FTP) username. The no form of this command removes an FTP username. Syntax ip ftp username username no ip ftp username [username] Parameters Parameter username Description Alpha-numeric-symbolic characters of the username, range is 1 to 25 characters, embedded spaces and quotation marks are not allowed.
ip host
Assigns a host name to an IP address or multiple IP addresses. The no form of this command
5-137
ip mask-reply
Enables sending ICMP Mask Reply messages. The no form of this command disables sending ICMP Mask Reply messages (default). Syntax ip mask-reply no ip mask-reply Mode Interface Configuration (Admin, Loopback, NNET, Null, Em, Tunnel)
ip name-server
Sets one or more Domain Name System (DNS) server IP addresses. The no form of this command removes one or more DNS server IP addresses. Syntax ip name-server {ip-address | ipv6-address}... no ip name-server [ip-address]...
5-138
Parameters Parameter ip name-server ipv6-address Mode Global Configuration Guidelines This command adds IP address entries to an internal list. This command is denied if the internal list would exceed a maximum of 3 entries. When multiple name servers are specified, the server determined to be nearest (based on response times) is used. Description IPv4 address of a DNS server. IPv6 address of a DNS server
ip nat
This command configures IP address translation and port address translation rules to be applied to an interface. Packets received or sent on the configured interface with the IP address or IP address port specified, are modified according to the mapping defined. The terms private and public are used in the command definition as a convenience for frame of reference. NAT rules are specified for the interface receiving packets from the public address space and translated to the private address space. The reverse mapping is performed for packets transmitted via the interface. No checking is done if the addresses are actually private or public. The no form of this command removes one or more address translation rules. NOTE: As specific packet flows are detected, the system allocates specific NAT entries for each flow to expedite forwarding. When the no form of the command is given, the flow specific rule is not deleted. The rule is deleted when the packet flow is no longer being received. This allows for the smallest disruption in packet flow when rules are being redefined. Syntax ip nat interface <interface> { public-ip <public-ipv4-addr> private-ip <private-ipv4-addr> | public-ip-port <public-ipv4-addr> <public-port> private-ip-port <private-ipv4-addr> <privateport> } no ip nat [interface <interface> [ public-ip <public-ipv4-addr> private-ip <private-ipv4-addr> | public-ip-port <public-ipv4-addr> <public-port> private-ip-port <private-ipv4-addr> <privateport> ] ] Parameters
5-139
Parameter public-ipv4-addr
Description IPv4 address received on the interface that will be mapped to private IPv4 address. IPv4 address which replaces the privateipv4-address when packet is transmitted on the interface. IPv4 address which replaces the publicipv4- address upon reception. IPv4 address transmitted on the interface that will be mapped to the public-ipv4-address. Port number in packets received on the interface that is mapped to private-port. Port number which replaces private-port when packets are transmitted on interface. Port number which replaces the public-port in received packets. Port number which is replaced by the public-port when packets are transmitted.
private-ipv4-addr
public-port
private-port
ip ospf authentication-key
Sets the simple password to be used for this interface by neighboring routers. The no form of this command removes the password. Syntax ip ospf authentication-key [encryption-type] password no ip ospf authentication-key [encryption-type] [password] Parameters Parameter encryption-type Description Number specifying the type of password encryption to use when storing and displaying the password, range is 0 to 7, default is 0 (no encryption). Simple password to be used by neighboring routers, a continuous string of characters, up to 8 bytes long.
password
5-140
ip ospf authentication
Sets the OSPF authentication to the specified type (or simple authentication if none specified). The no form of this command sets the OSPF authentication to the type specified for the OSPF area (default). Syntax ip ospf authentication [null | message-digest] no ip ospf authentication [null | message-digest] Parameters Parameter null message-digest Description No authentication will be used on the interface. MD5 authentication will be used on the interface.
ip ospf cost
Sets the cost of sending packets out this interface. The no form of this command sets the cost to the default value. Syntax ip ospf cost cost no ip ospf cost [cost] Parameters Parameter Description
5-141
cost
16-bit integer representing the cost of using this interface for outgoing packets, range is 1 to 65535, default is reference-bandwidth (108, or the value specified in auto-cost referencebandwidth) divided by the interface bandwidth.
ip ospf database-filter
Enables the filtering of all outgoing LSAs to an interface. The no form of this command disables the filtering of all outgoing LSAs (default). Syntax ip ospf database-filter all out no ip ospf database-filter all out Mode Interface Configuration (Loopback, Em, Tunnel)
ip ospf dead-interval
Sets the maximum amount of time that this routers neighbors will wait for Hello packets before declaring this router dead (down). The no form of this command sets this value to the default Syntax ip ospf dead-interval seconds no ip ospf dead-interval [seconds] Parameters Parameter seconds Description Amount of time in seconds that this routers neighbors will wait for Hello packets from this router before declaring this router dead, range is 1 to 65535, defaults are: 40 for broadcast, 120 for NBMA, 120 for point-tomultipoint, 40 for point-to-point networks (4 times the value of ip ospf hello-interval).
5-142
ip ospf flood-reduction
Enables flood-reduction for this interface. The no form of this command disables flood-reduction (default). Syntax ip ospf flood-reduction no ip ospf flood-reduction Mode Interface Configuration (Loopback, Em, Tunnel)
ip ospf hello-interval
Sets the amount of time that this router waits between sending Hello packets on this interface. The no form of this command sets this value to the default. Syntax ip ospf hello-interval seconds no ip ospf hello-interval [seconds] Parameters Parameter seconds Description Amount of time in seconds that passes between the sending of Hello packets on this interface, range is 1 to 65535, defaults are: 10 for broadcast, 30 for NBMA, 30 for point-tomultipoint, 10 for point-to-point.
5-143
ip ospf message-digest-key
Sets the MD5 key to be used for this interface by neighboring routers. The no form of this command removes the key. Syntax ip ospf message-digest-key key-id md5 [encryption-type] key no ip ospf message-digest-key key-id md5 [encryption-type] [key] Parameters Parameter key-id encryption-type Description Identifier for the MD5 key, range is 1 to 255. Number specifying the type of encryption to use when storing and displaying the md5 key, range is 0 to 7, default is 0 (no encryption). Alphanumeric string of up to 16 characters that is the value of the MD5 key.
key
Mode Interface Configuration (Loopback, Em, Tunnel) Guidelines If the command password-encryption has been enabled, all passwords are encrypted for storage and display, regardless of the encryption type parameter specified here.
ip ospf network
Sets the OSPF network to be a type other than the default for this interface. The no form of this command sets the network type to the default. Syntax ip ospf network {broadcast | non-broadcast | point-to-point | point-to-multipoint} no ip ospf network [broadcast | non-broadcast | point-to-point | point-to-multipoint] Parameters
5-144
Description Configures the network as a broadcast network. Configures the network as a non-broadcast multi-access (NBMA) network. Configures the network as point-to-point. Configures the network as point-tomultipoint.
ip ospf priority
Sets the RCP priority, which is used in the election of Designated Routers. The no form of this command sets the RCP priority value to the default value. Syntax ip ospf priority number no ip ospf priority [number] Parameters Parameter number Description Priority value for this router, range is 0 to 255, default is 1.
Mode Interface Configuration (Loopback, Em, Tunnel) Guidelines Setting the IP OSPF priority to zero makes the RCP ineligible to become designated router or backup designated router for this LAN segment.
ip ospf retransmit-interval
Sets the retransmit interval for the RCP. The no form of this command sets the value to the default. Syntax
5-145
ip ospf transmit-delay
Sets the retransmit interval for the RCP. The no form of this command sets the value to the default. Syntax ip ospf transmit-delay seconds no ip ospf transmit-delay [seconds] Parameters Parameter seconds Description Amount of time in seconds to wait before retransmitting unacknowledged OSPF packets, range is 1 to 65535, default is 5.
ip prefix-list
Creates a prefix-list. The no form of this command deletes either the entire prefix-list (if a specific deny or permit clause is not given) or the deny or permit clause specified. Syntax ip prefix-list prefix-list-id [seq sequence-number] {deny | permit} {ip-address/mask-length} [ge mask-length] [le mask-length]
5-146
le mask-length
ip prefix-list description
Assigns a descriptive string to a prefix-list. The no form of this command un-assigns the descriptive string from a prefix-list. Syntax ip prefix-list prefix-list-id description description-string no ip prefix-list prefix-list-id description [description-string] Parameters Parameter prefix-list-id description-string Description Name of the prefix-list for which a description is being added. Text describing the prefix-list, may contain up to 80 characters.
5-147
ip prefix-list sequence-number
Enables the automatic generation of sequence numbers for items in a prefix-list (default). The no form of this command disables automatic generation of sequence numbers. Syntax ip prefix-list sequence-number no ip prefix-list sequence-number Mode Global Configuration
ip proxy-arp
Enables proxy ARP (Address Resolution Protocol) on an interface (default). The no form of this command disables proxy ARP on an interface. Syntax ip proxy-arp no ip proxy-arp Mode Interface Configuration (Port-chan) Subinterface Configuration (Port-chan)
ip qsr-export host
To add a host that can receive QSR reports via ftp, use ip qsr-export host command. Multiple hosts can be configured. Syntax ip qsr-export host { {primary | alternate } <ip-address> ftp username <username> [encrypted] password <password> } no ip qsr-export host { primary | alternate } [ <ip-address> ] [ ftp username <username> [encrypted] password <password> ]
5-148
ip qsr-export interval
To set the QSR report generation interval, use ip qsr-export interval command. Syntax ip qsr-export interval {hours <hh> [base-export-time <hh:mm>]} no ip qsr-export interval [hours <hh> ] [base-export-time <hh:mm>] Parameters Parameter base-export-time <hh:mm> hours <hh> Mode Global configuration Description Interval time in hours:minutes format. Interval in hours (1--24).
ip radius source-interface
Sets the source address for all outgoing RADIUS packets to that of the specified interface. The no form of this command sets the source address for all outgoing RADIUS packets to the default interface value. Syntax ip radius source-interface interface-name no ip radius source-interface [interface-name]
5-149
Parameters Parameter interface-name Description {admin 0 | loopback loopback-number | nnet rcp-number | port-chan channelnumber[.subinterface] | pos-chan channelnumber | tunnel tunnel-number}.
ip receive access-list
Enables the RCP to conditionally process packets received by the RCP based on a specified rcp-receive access-list. The no form of this command removes the specification of an rcpreceive access-list. Syntax ip receive access-list access-list-id no ip receive access-list [access-list-id] Parameters Parameter access-list-id Mode Global Configuration Guidelines When an rcp-receive access-list is being applied by the RCP (through the ip receive access-list command) and a per-interface/global in access-list is also being applied by the RCP (through the interface/global ip access-group command), the per-interface/global access-list is processed first. If a permit or deny match is not found within the per-interface/global access-list, the rcpreceive access-list is then searched. If a permit or deny match is not found within the rcp-receive access-list, an implicit deny is performed Description Alphanumeric name string of the access-list.
ip redirects
Enables sending ICMP Redirect Messages on an interface (default). The no form of this command disables sending ICMP Redirect Messages.
5-150
ip routing
Enables IP routing on the RCP. The no form of this command disables IP routing. Syntax ip routing no ip routing Mode Global Configuration
ip route
To configure a static IP route, use the ip route command. The no form of the command deletes a static route. In this release, the only change to this command is to add the drib key word. Syntax ip route { <ip-address><ip-netmask> | <ip-address/mask-length> } { <ip-address> | { <interface-name-string> [ <ip-address> ]}} [ <distance-value> ] [permanent] [ tag <tag-value> ] [ drib <drib-name> ] no ip route { <ip-address><ip-netmask> | <ip-address/mask-length> } { <ip-address> | { <interface-name-string> [ <ip-address> ]}} [ <distance-value> ] [permanent] [ tag <tag-value> ] [ drib <drib-name> ] Parameters Parameter <ip-address><ip-netmask> <ip-address/mask-length> <ip-address> <interface-name-string> Description The parameter pairs to specify the destination IP address and netmask of the static route being created. IP address of the next hop to reach the static route. The interface name string defined with ifconfig.
5-151
<distance-value> <tag-value>
administrative distance to be used, the lower the number, the higher the trust rating, range is 1 to 255, default is 1. decimal value that can be used as a match value for controlling redistribution via route maps, range is 0 to 4294967295. The name of the DRIB, limited to 40 characters.
ip source-route
Sets router to process packets with IP source routing header options (default). The no form of this command sets router to drop packets with IP source routing header options. Syntax ip source-route no ip source-route Mode Global Configuration
ip subnet-zero
Enables the use of subnet-zero for interface addresses and in routing updates (default). Syntax ip subnet-zero Mode Global Configuration
ip tacacs source-interface
Sets the source address for all outgoing TACACS+ packets to that of the specified interface. The no form of this command sets the source address for all outgoing TACACS+ packets to the default interface value. Syntax
5-152
ip tcp path-mtu-discovery
Enables path MTU discovery for all new TCP connections from the RCP (default). The no form of this command disables this function. Syntax ip tcp path-mtu-discovery no ip tcp path-mtu-discovery Mode Global Configuration
ip telnet source-interface
Sets the Telnet connection source address to that of the specified interface. The no form of this command sets the Telnet connection source address to the default interface value. Syntax ip telnet source-interface interface-name no ip telnet source-interface [interface-name] Parameters Parameter Description
5-153
interface-name
{admin 0 | loopback loopback-number | nnet rcp-number | port-chan channelnumber[.subinterface] | pos-chan channelnumber | tunnel tunnel-number}.
ip unnumbered
Enables IP processing on an interface without an explicit IP address. The no form of this command disables IP processing on an interface without an explicit IP address (default). Syntax ip unnumbered interface-name no ip unnumbered [interface-name] Parameters Parameter interface-name Description {admin 0 | loopback loopback-number | nnet rcp-number | port-chan channelnumber[.subinterface] | pos-chan channelnumber | tunnel tunnel-number}.
Mode Interface Configuration (Loopback, Pos-chan, Tunnel) Subinterface Configuration Guidelines This command is denied if the specified interface does not have an assigned IP address.
ip unreachables
Enables sending ICMP Unreachable Messages on an interface (default). The no form of this command disables sending ICMP Unreachable Messages. Syntax ip unreachables no ip unreachables
5-154
ip-to-dn host
In some UNIStim deployments, accurately detecting the UNIStim phone number associated with the calling and/or called party phone is not possible. This command enables acquisition of the phone IP address to Directory Number mappings via a network database. When this capability is enabled, the SVP will query the database at SVP startup and once every day at a time specified by this command. If the database query does not succeed, the SVP will retry at an interval configured by this command. This command replaces all settings associated with this configuration. The no version of this command regardless of the parameters specified, disables the database acquisition.
Syntax ip-to-dn host <ip-address> [port <port>] username <username> [encrypted] password <password> [{access-type cicm-xml}] [time-of-day <hh:mm>] [retry <retry>] no ip-to-dn host <ip-address> [port <port>] username <username> [encrypted] password <password> [{access-type cicm-xml}] [time-of-day <hh:mm>] [retry <retry>]
Parameters Parameter ip-address port username <username> password <password> encrypted Description IP address of the network database. port number for access. Name of the user access login. Password for the user. [Optional] Indicates that the entered password string is encrypted. This option is included by the system as part of the running configuration. Currently only the CICM database is supported via XML. Time of day to perform daily database acquisition of the form hh:mm. cicm-xml 01:30 443 Default
access-type time-of-day
5-155
retry
Retry period if database acquisition fails. The value is specified in minutes from 10 to 120.
30
ip-to-dn poll
This command initiates a query of the IP to Directory Number network database. The access information for the poll must be configured with the ip-to-dn host command before the poll can successfully be performed. This command is intended to be used if changes to the database have been made and it is desirable for the SVP to become aware of the changes prior to the daily poll.
ipsec-tunnel bandwidth
To configure a fixed bandwidth value for all IPSec tunnels, use the ipsec -tunnel bandwidth command. The no form of the command sets the tunnel bandwidth to the default value. Note: When this command is entered, the new bandwidth value applies to the new tunnels only. The bandwidth value for the existing tunnels will not be changed. Syntax ipsec-tunnel bandwidth <bandwidth> no ipsec-tunnel bandwidth [<bandwidth>] Parameters Parameter Description Range Default
5-156
bandwidth
0 kbps
ipsec-tunnel short-duration
To configure the boundary time value to distinguish short duration tunnels from long duration tunnels use ipsec-tunnel short-duration command. The no-form command reverts the boundary time value to the default. Note: When the boundary duration is changed, the new boundary duration only applies to newly established tunnels. The existing tunnels will remain in their existing short or long duration categories. Syntax ipsec-tunnel short-duration less-than <time> no ipsec-tunnel short-duration less-than [<time>] Parameters Parameter duration Description Time boundary in minutes to distinguish short-duration tunnels from long duration tunnels. Range 1 60 minutes Default 5 minutes
ipv6 neighbor
Creates a static entry in the IPv6 neighbor discovery cache. The no form of this command deletes a static entry in the IPv6 neighbor discovery cache. Syntax ipv6 neighbor ipv6-address interface-name mac-address no ipv6 neighbor ipv6-address interface-name [mac-address]
5-157
mac-address
isis password
Enables authentication on the interface and sets the authentication password for this interface. The no form of this command removes the password (default). Syntax isis password password [level-1 | level-2] no isis password [password [level-1 | level-2]] Parameters Parameter password level-1 level-2 Description Authentication text password to be carried in Hello PDUs between neighbors (LAN-type interface option only) level 1 packets only. (LAN-type interface option only) level 2 packets only.
Mode Interface Configuration (Loopback, Em, Tunnel) Guidelines If neither level-1 nor level-2 is specified, the password is set for Level-1. If no parameters are given when issuing no isis password, only the level-1 password is removed.
5-158
isis-topology-map
This command enables inclusion of ISIS link state information into the topology map for determining router interface connectivity. The actual configuration of the protocol for peering must be done separately using router ISIS configuration commands. The no form of this command disables inclusion of this information. NOTE: This command has no effect on the ISIS peering state. Syntax isis-topology-map no isis-topology-map Mode Topology map configuration
jump
Performs jumping to another route-map if a preceding match statement was successful, in a route-map. The no form of this command removes the jump statement from the route-map. jump route-map-name no jump route-map-name Parameters Parameter route-map-name Mode IP Policy-List Configuration Route-Map Configuration Route-Map Assign Guidelines In order to avoid loops in processing route-maps, a jump statement cannot be placed in a routemap which is being jumped to by another route-map. Also, a jump statement cannot be entered into a route-map if the target route-map for the jump contains a jump statement. Description Name of the route-map to jump to.
keepalive
Enables and sets duration value for interface keepalive timers (default). The no form of this
5-159
kill
Terminates a specified user login or session. Syntax kill userid Parameters Parameter userid Mode Privileged EXEC Guidelines This command will terminate the login or session associated with the specified userID plus all related child sessions. Description Assigned user identification number.
length
Sets the number of display lines per screen. The no form of this command sets the number of display lines per screen to automatically be determined using the negotiated login window size (default). Syntax
5-160
Mode Line Configuration Guidelines This command is used to set the system default page size for paged output applications.
line
Enters Line Configuration Mode to configure the console and all tty lines. Syntax line Mode Global Configuration
link-bandwidth thresholds
To specify link bandwidth congestion threshold, use link-bandwidth threshold command. Topology alerts will be set or cleared based on the crossing of these thresholds. The no form command disables the thresholds and the alerts. These thresholds are used to monitor the links bandwidth reservation condition of ongoing sessions. Thresholds may be specified on a global or per link (indicated by node-id and if-index) basis. Link specific thresholds take precedence over global thresholds. When a no form command for link specific thresholds is entered, if the global thresholds exist, the global thresholds will be set on that link. If no global thresholds exist, then the topology alert is turned off. When the no form command for the global thresholds is entered, the links that have per link thresholds set will have the same thresholds in effect. The links that do not have per link thresholds set will have the alerts turned off. Syntax
5-161
no link-bandwidth thresholds [set-threshold <set-threshold > clear-threshold <clearthreshold > [node-id <node-id> if-index <if-index>]]
Parameters Parameter set-threshold Description Threshold value represented as a percentage of the link physical bandwidth. When the utilized bandwidth on the link becomes higher than this threshold, an alert will be set. This value must be greater than clear-threshold. The range is 2% -500%. Threshold value represented as a percentage of the link physical bandwidth. When the utilized bandwidth on the link becomes lower than this threshold, the previously set alert will be cleared. The range is 1% -499%. The value must be smaller than set-threshold. IP address that represents the node-id of a node in the network. Interface index number
clear-threshold
5-162
link-packet-drop thresholds
To specify link packet drop threshold, use link-packet-drop threshold command. Topology alerts will be set or cleared based on the crossing of these thresholds. The packet drop information is based on SNMP polling on the link(s). The no form command disables the thresholds and the alerts. Thresholds may be specified on a global or per link (indicated by node-id and if-index) basis. Link specific thresholds take precedence over global thresholds. When a no form command for link specific thresholds is entered, if the global thresholds exist, the global thresholds will be set on that link. If no global thresholds exist, then the topology alert is turned off. When the no form command for the global thresholds is entered, the links that have per link thresholds set will have the same thresholds in effect. The links that do not have per link thresholds set will have the alerts turned off. Syntax link-packet-drop thresholds set-threshold <link-pd-threshold> clear-threshold <link-pdthreshold> [node-id <ip-address> if-name <interface-name-string>] no link-packet-drop thresholds [set-threshold <link-pd-threshold> clear-threshold <linkpd-threshold> [node-id <ip-address> if-name <interface-name-string>]] Parameters Parameter Description
5-163
link-pd-threshold
Threshold value represented as a number of packets drop on the link. When the packets dropped on the link(s) become higher than set-threshold, an alert will be set. When the packets dropped on the link(s) become lower than the clear-threshold, the previously set alert will be cleared. The set-threshold value must be greater than clearthreshold. The range of the value is [1 ]. IP address that represents the node-id of a node in the network. The interface string name of the link.
list
Displays all or part of the explicit path or paths. Syntax list [starting-index-number] [detail] Parameters Parameter starting-index-number detail Mode IP Explicit Path Configuration Description Displays the list starting at the entry index number, range is 1 to 65535. Displays information in long form.
load-distribution
The SVP performs a default load distribution algorithm when selecting a path which is part of an ECMP. This command enables the SVP to gather information from the router to aid in customizing the algorithm to match the router's behavior. Currently on CEF behavior can be enhanced. NOTE: This feature relies on CLI polling being configured for the router in question. If it is not enabled, load distribution information will not be collected. If the no form of this command is issued, the system will not collect load distribution information from the router.
5-164
poll-multiple
logging console
Enables logging messages to the console (default). The no form of this command disables logging messages to the console. Syntax logging console [level] no logging console [level] Parameters Parameter level Description Valid integer (or alpha) values for level are: 0 (emergencies), 1 (alerts), 2 (critical), 3 (errors), 4 (warnings), 5 (notifications), 6 (information), and 7 (debugging) from highest to lowest priority, default is 7 (debugging).
5-165
Guidelines Higher-priority messages are logged when the logging level is set to lower levels. For example, if the logging level is set to critical (level 2), then emergencies (level 0) messages and alerts (level 1) messages will be logged.
logging enable
Enables DRP-related logging. The no form of this command disables DRP-related logging. Syntax logging enable {command_logging | console_logging | syslog_logging} no logging enable [command_logging | console_logging | syslog_logging] Parameters Parameter command_logging console_logging syslog_logging Mode Global Configuration Description Enables command logging. Enables console logging. Enables syslog logging.
logging facility
Sets a UNIX system facility where error messages are to be sent. The no form of this command sets the UNIX system facility value to the default value. Syntax logging facility facility-type no logging facility [facility-type] Parameters Parameter facility-type Description {local0 | local1 | local2 | local3 | local4 | local5 | local6 | local7} (all reserved for locally defined messages), default is local7.
5-166
logging history
Sets the alarm level at which alarms of equal or higher priority will be sent to the history table and to the SNMP network management station. Alternatively, with the size keyword specified, this command sets the number of syslog messages to be stored in the history table. The no logging history form of this command sets the history table alarm level to the default value. The no logging history size form of this command sets the history table size to the default value. Syntax logging history {level | size number} no logging history [level | size [number]] Parameters Parameter level Description Valid integer (or alpha) values for level are: 0 (emergencies), 1 (alerts), 2 (critical), 3 (errors), 4 (warnings), 5 (notifications), 6 (information), and 7 (debugging) from highest to lowest priority, default is 4 (warnings). Number of messages to be stored in the history table, range is 0 to 500, default is 1.
number
Mode Global Configuration Guidelines Higher-priority messages are logged when the logging level is set to lower levels. For example, if the logging level is set to critical (level 2), then emergencies (level 0) messages and alerts (level 1) messages will be logged.
logging host
Sets a specified remote server host to be a syslog server. The no form of this command deletes the remote server host from the list of syslog servers. The default is to have no remote host specified to be a syslog server. Syntax
5-167
logging monitor
Enables logging messages to the terminal lines. The no form of this command disables logging messages to terminal lines (default). This command does not apply to the console. Syntax logging monitor [level] no logging monitor [level] Parameters Parameter level Description Valid integer (or alpha) values for level are: 0 (emergencies), 1 (alerts), 2 (critical), 3 (errors), 4 (warnings), 5 (notifications), 6 (information), and 7 (debugging) from highest to lowest priority, default is 7 (debugging).
Mode Global Configuration Guidelines Higher-priority messages are logged when the logging level is set to lower levels. For example, if the logging level is set to critical (level 2), then emergencies (level 0) messages and alerts (level 1) messages will be logged.
logging on
5-168
logging source-interface
Sets the source IP address of all syslog packets to a specified value. The no form of this command sets the IP address of the interface used to leave the RCP to be issued within a syslog packet. Syntax logging source-interface interface-name no logging source-interface [interface-name] Parameters Parameter interface-name Description {admin 0 | loopback loopback-number | nnet rcp-number | port-chan channelnumber[.subinterface] | pos-chan channelnumber | tunnel tunnel-number}.
logging trap
Enables logging messages to the remote syslog servers (default). The no form of this command disables logging messages to the remote syslog servers. Syntax logging trap [level] no logging trap [level] Parameters
5-169
Parameter level
Description Valid integer (or alpha) values for level are: 0 (emergencies), 1 (alerts), 2 (critical), 3 (errors), 4 (warnings), 5 (notifications), 6 (information), and 7 (debugging) from highest to lowest priority, default is 6 (information).
Mode Global Configuration Guidelines Higher-priority messages are logged when the logging level is set to lower levels. For example, if the logging level is set to critical (level 2), then emergencies (level 0) messages and alerts (level 1) messages will be logged.
login
Creates a new session and suspends the current session. Syntax login Mode User EXEC
login backoff
Sets the number of consecutive failed login retries that triggers the start of backoff delays. The no form of this command sets the number of retries to the default value. Syntax login backoff retries [starting-delay] no login backoff [retries [starting-delay]] Parameters Parameter retries Description Number of consecutive failed login retries that triggers the start of backoff delays, range is 0 to 9, default is 2.
5-170
starting-delay
Mode Global Configuration Guidelines For each consecutive failed login retry after the first backoff delay occurs, the backoff delay is doubled.
login retries
Sets the number of consecutive failed login retries that triggers a disconnection. The no form of this command sets the number of retries to the default value. Syntax login retries retries no login retries [retries] Parameters Parameter retries Description Number of consecutive failed login retries that triggers the start of backoff delays, range is 0 to 9, default is 2.
Mode Global Configuration Guidelines If the number of retries that triggers a disconnection is set less than or equal to the number of retries that triggers the start of backoff delays, backoff delays are effectively disabled.
logout
Exits the EXEC mode and logs off the RCP. Syntax logout
5-171
mac-address
Sets the mac layer address for an Ethernet port. Syntax mac-address mac-address Parameters Parameter mac-address Description 48-bit IEEE MAC address using three 4-digit hex numbers separated by periods (xxxx.xxxx.xxxx).
maintenance-window
To specify a time window for SVP and SVM system maintenance routines to run, use the maintenance-window command. The no form of this command deletes the provisioned time window and reverts to the default maintenance window. If the maintenance window command is executed multiple times, the newer command will overwrite the existing maintenance window. Therefore, only the last maintenance window is remembered. Syntax maintenance-window {start-time <hh:mm> end-time <hh:mm>} [no] maintenance-window [start-time <hh:mm> end-time <hh:mm>] Parameters Parameter start-time <hh:mm> end-time <hh:mm> Mode Global Configuration Description The start time of the maintenance period, in hour, minute. The end time of the maintenance period, in hour, minute.
5-172
man
Displays on-line documentation of CLI commands in man-page format. Syntax man command-name Parameters Parameter command-name Description Name of the command for which documentation is requested.
match as-path
Assigns the specified as-path-access-list to be matched in a route-map. The no form of this command removes the match from the route-map. Syntax match as-path {as-path-access-list-id}... no match as-path [as-path-access-list-id]... Parameters Parameter as-path-access-list-id Mode IP Policy-List Configuration Description AS-path access list(s) to be matched.
match community
Assigns communities permitted by the given community-list to be matched in a route-map. The no form of this command removes the match from the route-map. Syntax match community {community-list-id}... [exact-match]
5-173
match expression
Assigns any variables that have been created with the assign command to be matched in a routemap. The no form of this command removes the match from the route-map. Syntax match expression logical-expression no match expression logical-expression Parameters Parameter logical-expression Description Assigned variables to be matched (a to z), valid logical operators are ( ), AND (&), OR ( | ) and NOT (~), with the precedence being NOT, AND, then OR.
match extcommunity
Assigns extended communities permitted by the given extended community-list to be matched in a route-map. The no form of this command removes the match from the route-map. Syntax
5-174
match interface
Assigns any routes that have their next hop out the interface to be matched in a route-map. The no form of this command removes the match from the route-map. Syntax match interface {interface-name}... no match interface {interface-name}... Parameters Parameter interface-name Description {loopback loopback-number | port-chan channel-number[.subinterface] | pos-chan channel-number | tunnel tunnel-number}.
match ip address
Assigns IP addresses that are permitted in the access-list(s) to be matched in a route-map. The no form of this command removes the match from the route-map.
5-175
match ip next-hop
Assigns next-hop router addresses that are permitted in the access-list(s) to be matched in a route-map. The no form of this command removes the match from the route-map. Syntax match ip next-hop {access-list-id}...
5-176
no match ip next-hop [access-list-id]... Parameters Parameter access-list-id Description Access-list of next-hop router addresses to be matched.
match ip route-source
Assigns routes that have come from the route-source addresses permitted in the access-list(s) to be matched in a route-map. The no form of this command removes the match from the routemap. Syntax match ip route-source {access-list-id}...
5-177
match local-preference
Assigns the specified local-preference to be matched in a route-map. The no form of this command removes the match from the route-map. Syntax match local-preference {local-preference-value}... no match local-preference {local-preference-value}...
5-178
match metric
Assigns routes that have the specified metric to be matched in a route-map. The no form of this command removes the match from the route-map. Syntax match metric {metric-value}... no match metric {metric-value}... Parameters Parameter metric-value Mode IP Policy-List Configuration Route-Map Configuration Route-Map Assign Description Route metric, range is 0 to 4294967295.
match policy-list
Sets a match statement into a route-map for one or more policy lists. The no form of this command removes the match statement from the route-map for one or more policy lists, or all policy lists if none specified. Syntax match policy-list {policy-list-id}... no match policy-list [policy-list-id]...
5-179
match route-type
Assigns routes of the type specified to be matched in a route-map. The no form of this command removes the match from the route-map. Syntax match route-type [external [type-1 | type-2]] [internal] [level-1] [level-2] [local] [nssaexternal [type-1 | type-2]] no match route-type [external [type-1 | type-2]] [internal] [level-1] [level-2] [local] [nssaexternal [type-1 | type-2]] Parameters Parameter external [type-1 | type-2] internal level-1 level-2 local nssa-external [type-1 | type-2] Description OSPF external type-1 or type-2 routes. OSPF intra-area and inter-area routes. IS-IS Level 1 routes. IS-IS Level 2 routes. Locally generated BGP routes. OSPF NSSA external type-1 or type-2 routes.
match tag
Assigns routes with the tag specified to be matched in a route-map. The no form of this command removes the match from the route-map.
5-180
Syntax match tag {tag-value}... no match tag [tag-value]... Parameters Parameter tag-value Description Route tag to be matched, range is 0 to 4294967295.
maximum-paths (BGP)
Sets the allowable maximum number of parallel routes to a destination. The no form of this command restores the maximum-paths value to its default. Syntax maximum-paths maximum-path-count no maximum-paths [maximum-path-count] Parameters Parameter maximum-path-count Description Maximum number of equal cost routes to a destination allowable in the routing table, range is 1 to 6, default is 1 for BGP and 4 for OSPF.
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast)
5-181
maximum-paths (OSPF)
Sets the allowable maximum number of parallel routes to a destination. The no form of this command restores the maximum-paths value to its default. Syntax maximum-paths maximum-path-count no maximum-paths [maximum-path-count] Parameters Parameter maximum-path-count Description Maximum number of equal cost routes to a destination allowable in the routing table, range is 1 to 6, default is 1 for BGP and 4 for OSPF.
max-metric
Enables the OSPF protocol to advertise a maximum metric so that other routers do not prefer the RCP as an intermediate hop in their SPF calculations. The no form of this command disables the advertisement of a maximum metric (default). Syntax max-metric router-lsa [on-startup {announce-time | wait-for-bgp}] no max-metric router-lsa [on-startup {announce-time | wait-for-bgp}] Parameters Parameter on-startup announce-time Description Causes the OSPF to advertise the maximum metric at startup time. Causes the OSPF to advertise the maximum metric for the specified time interval, range is 5 to 86,400 seconds.
5-182
wait-for-bgp
Causes the OSPF to advertise the maximum metric until BGP routing tables have converged or the default timer (600 seconds) has expired.
media-analysis
This command is used to customize the media analysis configuration. When the SVA performs analogue analysis for a voice call, it only analyzes a portion of the call. This allows more calls to be processed since it involves fewer system resources for caching the media stream and performing the analysis. The number of active calls to buffer is also configurable. This allows more calls to be analyzed but also delays when the system processing is completed following the end of the call. The longer this delay the more visible the metric graphs and alert declaration times will lag real-time. The optional call-sample-duration parameter can be used to limit the duration of the call on which echo analysis is performed. This parameter can be used to allow a longer period of time for signal analysis while limiting the impact to call analysis rates. The default duration without this parameter is the maximum-call-duration. The no form of the command regardless of parameters returns the settings to their system default. Syntax media-analysis minimum-call-duration <minimum-call-duration> maximum-call-duration <maximum-call-duration> maximum-buffered-calls <maximum-buffered-calls> [call-sampleduration <call-sample-duration>] no media-analysis [minimum-call-duration <minimum-call-duration> maximum-callduration <maximum-call-duration> maximum-buffered-calls <maximum-buffered-calls>] [call-sample-duration <call-sample-duration>] Parameters Parameter minimum-call-duration Description The minimum duration of the call required to do analysis. NOTE: the call duration starts when RTP is received in both directions of the call. The maximum duration of the call that will be analyzed. This limits the amount of memory required to cache the call. Range 10 - 60 seconds Default 20 seconds
maximum-call-duration
10 - 120 seconds
20 seconds
5-183
maximum-bufferedcalls
The maximum number of calls that are buffered at one time. The actual limit is dependent on the maximum-call-duration. Specifies a subset of the maximum-call-duration for performing echo analysis.
10 2000
50
call-sample-duration
10-30 seconds
20 seconds
minimum-sessions
During periods of very low user activity, it is possible that alerts will be generated when only one user activity fails. This may be undesirable depending on acceptable network performance. Likewise, if a very high level of network reliability is desired, alert generation should be very sensitive regardless of user activity. This command specifies the minimum number of sessions required during the previous alert generation period to allow alert generation. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of value, will return the minimum sessions for that interval to its default. The no form without any intervals specified, returns all intervals to their default value. Syntax minimum-sessions {[interval1 <session-count>] [interval2 <session-count>] [interval3 <session-count>] [interval4 <session-count>] } no minimum-sessions [[interval1 <session-count>] [interval2 <session-count>] [interval3 <session-count>] [interval4 <session-count>] ]
Parameters Parameter interval1 interval2 interval3 interval4 Description Minimum sessions for first interval of the day. Minimum sessions for second interval of the day. Minimum sessions for third interval of the day. Minimum sessions for fourth interval of the day. Type/Range 1-10000 1-10000 1-10000 1-10000 20 20 20 20 Default
Mode
5-184
missing-media
This command is used to enable the SVA to mark sessions when both directions of an RTP stream are not seen. The default is no session marking. The following cases are considered as part of this detection. The SVA is expected to receive media for every session monitored by its accompanying SVP. The SVA is expected to receive bidirectional media on some combination of interfaces for every session it receives media for. The SVA can be configured for any combination of these cases. The no form of this command regardless of parameters disables marking sessions. Syntax missing-media {[expect-all-sessions] [expect-bidirectional-media]} no missing-media [expect-all-sessions] [expect-bidirectional-media]
Parameters Parameter expect-all-sessions expect-bidirectional-media Description If the SVA is requested to monitor media for a session and no media is received, the session should be marked. If the SVA receives media for a session but does not receive both directions, the session should be marked.
mkdir
Creates a new file directory as a sub-directory within the current file directory. Syntax mkdir subdirectory Parameters Parameter Description
5-185
subdirectory
mmp
The SVA must be enabled to mark sessions when it detects media as missing or setting this threshold on the SVP will have no effect. This command specifies the percentage of sessions that were monitored and had missing media. If the calculated ratio is greater than the configured threshold, an alert will be generated. The command replaces the existing MMP settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the MMP alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the MMP alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS. The set threshold must be greater than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax mmp {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } no mmp {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter interval1 interval2 Description set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. If the percentage of sessions with missing media is greater than this value an alert will be sent. 0-99 Type/Range Default None None
5-186
clear
If the percentage of sessions missing media is less than or equal to this value the alert will be cleared.
0-99
none
monitor bgp
Displays BGP statistics in real time. The no form of this command disables this function. Syntax monitor bgp [display-interval] no monitor bgp [display-interval] Parameters Parameter display-interval Description Number of seconds between screen updates, range is 1 to 3600 seconds, default is 2
monitor interface
Displays interface statistics in real time. The no form of this command disables this function. Syntax monitor interface {interface-name | traffic} [display-interval] no monitor interface {interface-name | traffic} [display-interval] Parameters Parameter Description
5-187
interface-name
{admin 0 | loopback loopback-number | nnet rcp-number | null 0 | port-chan channel-number[.subinterface] | pos-chan channel-number | tunnel tunnel-number} Display traffic statistics on all interfaces. Number of seconds between screen updates, range is 1 to 3600 seconds, default is 2.
traffic display-interval
Guidelines The valid interface types on Admin Partition include: admin 0, loopback, nnet, and null 0. The valid interface types on Routing Partitions include: admin 0, gig-subif, loopback, null, port-chan, port-chan-subif, pos-subif, pos-chan, ten-subif, and tunnel.
monitor path
To specify a prefixed session for monitoring the path, use monitor path command. The no form command delete the prefixed session. This command is used to monitor a path and collect topology events along the path. This command creates a hypothetical session for user to monitor the topology events along its path. The no form can only remove a session added with monitor path command. Syntax monitor path {source-ip <ip-address> destination-ip <ip-address> [description <string>]} no monitor path {source-ip <ip-address> destination-ip <ip-address> [description <string>]} Parameters Parameter source-ip <ip-address> destination-ip <ip-address> description <string> Description These are mandatory parameters to define the source IP address and destination IP address of the session. Optional parameter to work as a signature or name of the prefixed session.
more begin
Displays more file output beginning with the line matched by the regular-expression.
5-188
Mode Privileged EXEC Guidelines The pipe symbol (|) is part of the command syntax and must be included.
more exclude
Displays more file output excluding the lines matched by the regular-expression. Syntax more file-url | exclude regular-expression Parameters Parameter file-url regular-expression Description Universal resource locator (url) of the file to search. Regular-expression to match text that is to be excluded in the search.
Mode Privileged EXEC Guidelines The pipe symbol (|) is part of the command syntax and must be included.
more include
5-189
Mode Privileged EXEC Guidelines The pipe symbol (|) is part of the command syntax and must be included.
motd-banner
Enables the message-of-the-day (MOTD) banner (default). The no form of this command disables the banner. motd-banner no motd-banner Mode Line Configuration
mount
Mounts a compact disk contained within the compact disk drive. Syntax mount cd Mode Privileged Exec
5-190
mtu
Sets the Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) value on an interface. The no form of this command sets the MTU value to the default value. Syntax mtu bytes no mtu [bytes] Parameters Parameter bytes Description IP MTU value in bytes (non inclusive of layer 2 overhead), range is 68 to 1500 for Admin and NNET; 68 to 65535 for Loopback, Null, and Tunnel; 68 to 9578 for Port-chan; and 68 to 9596 for Pos-chan; default is 1500 for Admin, NNET, and Portchan; 16384 for Loopback, and Null; and 4470 for Pos-chan and Tunnel. Subinterface defaults are same as parent interface. Mode Interface Configuration (Admin, Loopback, NNET, Null, Port-chan, Pos-chan, Tunnel) Subinterface Configuration (Port-chan) Guidelines There are more than one CLI commands used to configure MTU packet size. The MTU value (set by the mtu command) represents the interface MTU setting independent of a specific protocol. The IP MTU value (set by the ip mtu command), for example, represents the interface MTU setting specifically for the IP protocol. The IP MTU value can be affected by changing the MTU value. If the values of IP MTU and MTU have been configured to be equal with each other and the MTU value is changed, the IP MTU value is automatically changed to the new MTU value. However, changing the IP MTU value has no effect on the MTU value. The system will not allow the IP MTU value to be changed so that it is less than the MTU value.
nar
Network Availability Ratio (NAR) is a percentage of time the network is providing service. This is determined by subtracting the amount of time that no voice and/or data sessions are allowed. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the NAR alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the NAR alert for that time interval.
5-191
This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS based on the Network Availability Ratio. The set threshold must be less than or equal to the clear threshold per time interval. Syntax nar {[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] } no nar [[interval1 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3 set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4 set <set> clear <clear>] ] Parameters Parameter interval1 interval2 interval3 interval4 set Description set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. Value of ratio is less than this value, alert will set. Value of ratio is greater than or equal to this value, alert will clear. 00 to 100 where 00 implies off. 00 to 100 Type/Range Default None None None None 00
clear
00
neighbor
This command enables a COPS-RM neighbor relationship to be formed. Each SVP should be configured with the SVM as a neighbor and the SVM should be configured with each SVP as a neighbor. Peering between SVPs is done automatically based on router interface connectivity as determined and distributed by the SVM. The TCP connection can be secured using an MD5 digest. The password would need to be configured at the SVP and the SVM. Since inter-SVP peering is done automatically, all connections should use the same password. Syntax neighbor <router-id> [password [0..7] <string>]
5-192
no neighbor <router-id> [password [0..7] <string>] Parameters Parameter router-id Description IP address identifying the router ID of the neighbor. MD5 case sensitive password string. password display encryption type Type/Range IP address in dotted notation String 0 to 7 Default None.
None. None
neighbor activate
Enables a specific address-family for the given neighbor, according to the current Address Family Configuration Mode. The no form of this command disables the address-family on the peering session. Syntax neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} activate no neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} activate Mode Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Multicast) Guidelines In IPv4, the neighbor is automatically activated once the neighbor remote-as command has been issued. Once there are no address-families left on the peering session, it is shut down.
neighbor allowas-in
5-193
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Multicast)
neighbor block-updates
Disables sending and receiving routing updates to/from a peer router. The no form of this command enables the routing updates. Syntax neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} block-updates no neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} block-updates Parameters Parameter Description
5-194
Name of the BGP peer group. IPv4 or IPv6 address of the neighbor router.
both
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Multicast)
both Mode
Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Multicast) Guidelines This command cannot be invoked from VPNv4/VPNv6 RD configuration sub-mode.
5-196
both Mode
Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Multicast) Guidelines This command cannot be invoked from VPNv4/VPNv6 RD configuration sub-mode.
neighbor description
This command associates a description string with a copsrm neighbor. The description is only for user convenience. The no form regardless of parameter value removes the description string. Syntax neighbor <router-id> description <string> no neighbor <router-id> description <string> Parameters Parameter Description Type/Range Default
5-197
router-id
IP address identifying the router ID of the neighbor. Text description string up to 80 characters.
None.
description
None.
neighbor distribute-list
Establishes filters on inbound or outbound routes matching the specified access-list. The no form of this command disables the filtering. Syntax neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} distribute-list {access-list-id} {in | out} no neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} distribute-list {access-list-id} {in | out} Parameters Parameter ip-address peer-group-name access-list-id in out Description Address of the neighbor router. Name of the BGP peer group. Access list that determines filtered routes. Applies filtering to inbound routes from the specified peer-group or neighbor Applies filtering to outbound routes to the specified peer-group or neighbor.
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Multicast)
5-198
neighbor dont-capability-negotiate
Enables the router to perform Capability Parameter negotiation in BGP Open messages. The no form of this command enables the router to perform Capability Parameter negotiation (default). Syntax neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} dont-capability-negotiate no neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} dont-capability-negotiate Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF)
neighbor ebgp-multihop
Creates a BGP neighbor session with an external BGP peer that is logically, but not physically, connected. The no form of this command removes the ebgp multihop neighbor session. Syntax neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} ebgp-multihop [ttl-value] no neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} ebgp-multihop [ttl-value] Parameters Parameter peer-group ip-address Description BGP peer-group with which to establish an external BGP multihop session. IPv4 or IPv6 address of the BGP peer with which to establish an external BGP multihop session. Time-to-live value (max hop count) of the ebgp multihop neighbor, range is 1 to 255, default is 255. Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF)
ttl-value
5-199
neighbor eliminate-private-as
Removes all private autonomous system numbers from the as-path in routing updates to or from the specified neighbor. The no form of this command disables this function (default). Syntax neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} eliminate-private-as [in | out] no neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} eliminate-private-as [in | out] Parameters Parameter peer-group Description AS-path contains no private AS system numbers in routing updates to or from this BGP peer-group. AS-path contains no private AS system numbers in routing updates to or from this BGP peer address Private autonomous system numbers are eliminated from the as-path in routing updates from the specified neighbor Private autonomous system numbers are eliminated from the as-path in routing updates to the specified neighbor
ip-address
in
out
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Multicast) Guidelines If neither in nor out is specified, private-as numbers are removed from both incoming and outgoing routing updates. This command can be set independently for each peer-group member.
5-200
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Multicast)
5-201
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Multicast)
neighbor local-as
Enables this router to be a member of a second autonomous AS (the local-as-number), which is used when peering with the specified external neighbor or peer-group. The no form of this command removes the routers membership from the second AS. Syntax neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} local-as local-as-number [no-prepend] no neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} local-as [local-as-number [no-prepend]] Parameters Parameter Description
5-202
peer-group
When peering with this BGP peer-group, the RCP appears to be a member of the localas-number rather than its primary AS number. When peering with this BGP peer, the RCP appears to be a member of the localasnumber rather than its primary AS number. Autonomous system number (or symbol, if created with define as) of the second AS to which this router is being added. Forces EBGP peers not to prepend their asnumber to the as-path string of advertised routes when local-as is used.
ip-address
local-as-number
no-prepend
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Multicast)
neighbor maximum-prefix
Sets how many prefixes can be received from the specified neighbor. The no form of this command removes the maximum-prefix limit for the neighbor (default). Syntax neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} maximum-prefix prefix-limit [warning-threshold] [warningonly] no neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} maximum-prefix [prefix-limit [warning-threshold] [warning-only]] Parameters Parameter peer-group Description BGP peer-group for which the prefix limit is being specified.
5-203
ip-address prefix-limit
IPv4 or IPv6 address of the BGP peer for which the prefix limit is being specified. Maximum number of prefixes that can be received from the specified neighbor, range is 1 to 4294967295.
warning-threshold
After the RCP has received this percentage of the maximum number of prefixes from the specified neighbor, the RCP begins to generate warning signals, range is 1 to 100 percent of the prefix-limit, default is 75 percent. Router continues to peer with the specified neighbor even after the maximum number of prefixes has been reached; warnings are generated but the session is not ended.
warning-only
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Multicast)
neighbor next-hop-self
Sets this routers address as the next-hop router in routes sent to the neighbor specified. The no form of this command disables this function (default). Syntax neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} next-hop-self. no neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} next-hop-self Parameters Parameter peer-group Description BGP peer-group that will receive routes with this (the RCP being configured) routers address as the next-hop router.
5-204
ip-address
Address of the BGP peer that will receive routes with this (the RCP being configured) routers address as the next-hop router.
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Multicast)
neighbor next-hop-unchanged
Enables an exterior BGP (eBGP) multihop peer to propagate the next hop without changing it. The no form of this command disables this function (default). Syntax neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} next-hop-unchanged no neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} next-hop-unchanged Parameters Parameter peer-group ip-address Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Multicast) Description Next-hop BGP peer-group. Next-hop IP address.
5-205
neighbor password
Enables MD5 authentication on a TCP connection between two BGP peers. The no form of this command disables the MD5 authentication (default). Syntax neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} password [encryption-type] password-string no neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} password [encryption-type] [password-string] Parameters Parameter peer-group ip-address encryption-type Description BGP peer-group with which to use MD5 authentication. Address of the BGP peer with which to use MD5 authentication. Type of encryption to use when storing and displaying the MD5 password, range is 0 to 7, default is 0 (no encryption). Password of up to 80 letters.
password-string Mode
Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Guidelines If the command password-encryption has been enabled, all passwords are encrypted for storage and display, regardless of the encryption type specified with this command.
5-206
Parameter peer-group Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Guidelines
A peer group can be either all internal or all external. If the peer group is internal, the asnumber of all members must match the as-number of the BGP instance. If the peer group is external, no member of the peer group can have an as-number that matches the as-number of the BGP instance. If the peer group itself has an as-number, all members of the peer-group inherit that as-number and cannot change it while a member of the group. The group members are all either internal or external based on the as-number of the group If the peer group has an implicit (from its members) remote-as, that implicit remote-as and the internal/external restrictions on adding members are removed when all members are removed from the peer group.
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF)
5-207
5-208
neighbor precedence
Sets the specified neighbors precedence for disp lay and relative importance. The no form of this command causes the RCP to set the precedence value to 0 (default). Syntax neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} precedence precedence
5-209
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF)
neighbor prefix-list
Establishes filters on inbound or outbound routes in the specified prefix-list. The no form of this command disables the filtering. Syntax neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} prefix-list prefix-list-id {in | out} no neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} prefix-list prefix-list-id {in | out} Parameters Parameter peer-group ip-address prefix-list-id in out Description BGP peer-group to which the filtering applies. Address of the BGP peer to which the filtering applies. Prefix list to be applied to determine filtered routes. Applies filtering to inbound routes from the specified peer-group or neighbor. Applies filtering to outbound routes to the specified peer-group or neighbor.
5-210
neighbor remote-as
Sets a neighbor to the BGP neighbor table. The no form of this command removes the specified neighbor from the table. Syntax neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} remote-as as-number no neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} [remote-as [as-number]] Parameters Parameter peer-group ip-address as-number Description Neighbor BGP peer-group to be added. Address of the neighbor BGP peer to be added. Neighbors autonomous system number (or symbol, if created with define as).
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF)
neighbor remove-private-as
Removes private autonomous system numbers from the AS_path in outbound routing updates to the specified neighbor. The no form of this command disables this function (default). Syntax
5-211
ip-address
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Multicast)
neighbor route-map
Enables the specified route-map to be applied to incoming or outgoing route updates to the specified neighbor. The no form of this command stops the specified route-map from being applied. Syntax neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} route-map route-map-name {in | out} no neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} route-map route-map-name {in | out} Parameters Parameter peer-group ip-address Description BGP peer-group to which the route-map applies. Address of the BGP peer to which the routemap applies.
5-212
route-map-name in out
Route-map to be applied to ingoing or outgoing routes. Applies the route-map to inbound routes from the specified peer-group or neighbor. Applies the route-map to outbound routes to the specified peer-group or neighbor.
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Multicast)
neighbor route-reflector-client
Enables the router to be a BGP route reflector and sets the specified neighbor as its client. The no form of this command removes the neighbor as a client. Syntax neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} route-reflector-client no neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} route-reflector-client Parameters Parameter peer-group ip-address Description BGP peer-group that will be a client of this BGP route-reflector. Address of the BGP peer that will be a client of this BGP route-reflector.
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF)
5-213
neighbor send-community
Enables the router to send COMMUNITY attributes to the specified BGP neighbor. The no form of this command disables the router from sending COMMUNITY attributes (default). Syntax neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} send-community [both | extended | standard] no neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} send-community [both | extended | standard] Parameters Parameter peer-group ip-address both extended standard Description BGP peer-group to which COMMUNITY attributes are sent. Address of the BGP peer to which COMMUNITY attributes are sent. Sends both standard and extended COMMUNITY attributes. Sends only extended COMMUNITY attributes. Sends only standard COMMUNITY attributes (default if no type is specified).
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Multicast)
neighbor shutdown
5-214
ip-address
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast)
5-215
neighbor timers
This command specifies the COPS-RM keep alive and dead timer values for a neighbor. A keep alive timer value of 0 turns off the sending of keep alive messages. The no form of this command regardless of parameter value, removes the neighbor setting and the global configuration is used instead. Syntax neighbor <router-id> timers <tx-keep-alive-interval> <rx-dead-interval> no neighbor <router-id> timers <tx-keep-alive-interval> <rx-dead-interval> Parameters Parameter router-id Description IP address identifying the router ID of the neighbor. Time in seconds between sending of keep alive messages. Time lapse between messages before peer is assumed dead. Type/Range IP address in dotted notation 0-65535 seconds 0-65535 seconds Default None.
tx-keep-aliveinterval rx-dead-interval
60 180
neighbor unsuppress-map
Applies the specified route-map toward the specified neighbor to selectively unsuppress routes suppressed by aggregation. The no form of this command disables this function. Syntax neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} unsuppress-map route-map-name no neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} unsuppress-map route-map-name
5-216
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Multicast)
neighbor update-source
Enables internal BGP sessions on the router to use the specified interface for TCP connections with the specified neighbor. The no form of this command restores the interface assignment to the closest interface, which is called the best local address. Syntax neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} update-source interface-name no neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} update-source [interface-name] Parameters Parameter peer-group ip-address Description BGP peer-group that will use the interface for TCP connections with this router. Address of the BGP peer that will use the interface for TCP connections with this router. {loopback loopback-number | port-chan channel-number[.subinterface] | pos-chan channel-number | tunnel tunnel-number}.
interface-name
5-217
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF)
neighbor version
Sets a particular BGP version to be used with the specified neighbor. The no form of this command uses the neighbors default BGP version. Syntax neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} version version-number no neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} version [version-number] Parameters Parameter peer-group ip-address interface-name Description BGP peer-group for which the BGP version is being set. Address of the BGP peer for which the BGP version is being set. BGP version number to be used with this neighbor, the only valid value is 4.
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF)
neighbor weight
Sets a network weight to routes from the specified neighbor. Routes learned from this neighbor will have the assigned weight initially. The no form of this command removes the weight assignment for this neighbor. Syntax neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} weight weight-value no neighbor {peer-group | ip-address} weight [weight-value]
5-218
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Multicast) Guidelines The weights assigned in route-maps override the weights assigned using the neighbor weight and neighbor filter-list commands.
netflow-collection
The SVP can be enabled to collect NetFlow records using this command. The records are analyzed per router interface direction. Each router for which the SVP should collect NetFlow information must be enabled via the netflow-receive command. This command provisions up to two ports that the SVP will listen to for NetFlow records. This command also provisions the aggregation limit used by the SVP. As the SVP receives records it identifies the top users of the interface bandwidth. The number of top users the SVP will identify is controlled by the aggregation-limit parameter. Using the NetSocket GUI, the operator can configure IP subnets or layer 4 port ranges so that multiple flows can be viewed as a single user in the list of user flows. In order to provide to a second level of inspection for a specific user, the SVP must save the flow records associated with that user. Depending on the desired visibility and the available processing and storage on the SVP, the system can save the netflow information differently. The flow-record parameter controls how this information is saved. not-saved - No flow records are saved to disk. The system will still give summarized
5-219
By default the SVP will not listen for NetFlow records. The no form of this command regardless of parameters returns the system to the default state. Syntax netflow-collection [udp-port1 <udp-port1> [udp-port2 <udp-port2>]] [aggregation-limit <aggregation-limit>] [flow-record { not-saved | no-aggregation | aggregation | applicationaggregation}] no netflow-collection [udp-port1 <udp-port1> [udp-port2 <udp-port2>]] [aggregation-limit <aggregation-limit>] [flow-record { not-saved | no-aggregation | aggregation | applicationaggregation}]
Parameters Parameter udp-port1 udp-port2 aggregationlimit flow-record Description UDP port for receiving NetFlow records.. Second UDP port for receiving NetFlow records.. Bounds the size of the top users that will be tracked per router interface direction. Defines how flow records are stored. See explanation above. Type/Range 1000-65535 1000-65535 10-100 Default 9995 Disabled 30
applicationaggregation
netflow-receive
5-220
The SVP can be enabled to collect NetFlow records using the netflow-collector command. The netflow-receive command enables reception of records from a specific router. Records received from routers which have not been enabled will be ignored. This command identifies the source IP address used by the sending router. A template-timeout parameter is also available for timing out stale version 9 templates. By default the SVP will not process records received from routers. The no form of this command regardless of parameters returns the system to the default state. Syntax netflow-receive ip-address <ip-address> [template-timeout <template-timeout>] no netflow-receive [ip-address <ip-address>] [template-timeout <template-timeout>]
Parameters Parameter ip-address templatetimeout Description Source IP address in sender's Netflow messages. If a previously received template is not refreshed within this timeout period, the template is no longer considered valid. 1-3600 minutes Type/Range Default disabled 35
netstat
Displays network status information. Syntax netstat [routing-tables][partition partition-number] Parameters Parameter partition-number Description Router partition from which information is requested, range is 0-5.
5-221
Guidelines If a partition number is not specified, information is retrieved from the active partition. Output Address Local address. Proto Protocol of active sockets. Recv-Q Receive queue size in bytes. Send-Q Send queue size in bytes. Local Address Local address of the active socket. Foreign Address Remote address of the active socket. (state) State of the active socket. Inode Kernel address of the file system object handle. Conn Kernel address of the protocol control block. Refs Referencing socket linked list. Nextref Kernel link list link address. Add Name of files system object. Destination Destination to use when forwarding packets. Gateway Gateway to use when forwarding packets. Flags Information about the route indicated by the following character flags: 1 Protocol-specific routing flag #1. 2 Protocol-specific routing flag #2. 3 Protocol-specific routing flag #3. B Discard packets. b Route represents a broadcast address. C Clone new routes. c Protocol-specified clone new routes. D Created dynamically. G Forwarding by gateway. H Host entry. L Link address translation. M Modified dynamically. R Host or net unreachable. S Statically added. U Route usable. W Route was cloned. X External daemon translates protocol to link address. Netif Name of network interface. Expire Time (in seconds) until the route expires.
network
Sets a network to be advertised by this router. The no form of this command removes the network from the list of advertised routes. Syntax network {ip-address [mask netmask] | ip-address/mask-length} [weight weight-value] [routemap route-map-name] [backdoor]
5-222
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Multicast) Guidelines ip-address netmask or ip-address/mask-length must be of ipv4 address format if this command is invoked in one of the IPv4/VPNv4 address family modes (Unicast/Unicast VRF and Multicast). ip-address netmask or ip-address/mask-length must be of ipv6 address format if this command is invoked in one of the IPv6/VPNv6 address family modes (Unicast/Unicast VRF and Multicast).
network area
Enables one or more interfaces to run OSPF, and specifies the areas to which those OSPF
5-223
area-id
ip-address
no area
Removes the specified OSPF area. Syntax no area {area-id | ip-address} Parameters Parameter area-id ip-address Description Area to be deleted, expressed in decimal format, range is 0 to 4294967295. Area to be deleted, expressed as an IP address (dotted decimal).
5-224
ntp authenticate
Enables the NTP authentication feature (default). The no form of this command disables the NTP authentication feature. Syntax ntp authenticate no ntp authenticate Mode Global Configuration
ntp authentication-key
Specifies an authentication key for the NTP authentication feature. The no form of this command removes an authentication key. Syntax ntp authentication-key key-number md5 [encryption-type] key-value no ntp authentication-key key-number [md5 [encryption-type] key-value] Parameters Parameter key-number md5 encryption-type Description Key number, range is 1 to 65534. Use Message Digest 5 algorithm. Specifies whether the key that follows is encrypted. A value of 0 (default) indicates the following key is not encrypted, and a value of 7 indicates the following key is encrypted. Key value, range is 1 to 8 alpha-numericsymbolic characters (cannot begin with a # character and spaces are not allowed).
key-value
Mode
5-225
ntp broadcast
Enables an interface to send Network Time Protocol (NTP) broadcast packets. The no form of this command disables an interface to send NTP broadcast packets (default). Syntax ntp broadcast *[key key-number | version ntp-version] no ntp broadcast *[key key-number | version ntp-version] Parameters Parameter key-number Description Authentication key number, range is 1 to 65534 (as determined by the ntp authentication-key command), default is no encryption. NTP version number, range is 1 to 4, default is 4.
ntp-version
Mode Interface Configuration (Admin, Loopback, NNET, Null, Port-chan, Pos-chan, Tunnel) Subinterface Configuration (Port-chan)
ntp broadcastdelay
5-226
ntp master
Enables the router to be configured as an independent time source based on the local clock of the router. The no form of this command disables this function (default). Syntax ntp master [stratum] no ntp master [stratum] Parameters Parameter stratum Mode Global Configuration Description Stratum number, range is 1 to 15.
ntp on
Enables NTP (Network Time Protocol) operation (default). The no form of this command disables NTP operation. Syntax ntp on
5-227
ntp peer
Enables system clock peer-type synchronization with an NTP server. The no form of this command disables system clock peer-type synchronization with an NTP server (default). Syntax ntp peer ip-address *[key key-number | prefer | version ntp-version] no ntp peer ip-address *[key key-number | prefer | version ntp-version] Parameters Parameter ip-address key-number Description IP address of the peer. Authentication key number, range is 1 to 65534 (as determined by the ntp authentication-key command), default is no encryption. Specifies that this is the preferred peer. NTP version number, range is 1 to 4, default is 4.
prefer ntp-version
ntp restrict-list
Creates NTP access control restrict-list entries. The no form of this command removes NTP access control restrict-list entries.
5-228
ntp server
Enables system clock client-type synchronization with an NTP server. The no form of this command disables system clock client-type synchronization with an NTP server (default). The NTP server can be configured using the hostname. The system will perform DNS lookup and resolve the name to an IP address. The IP address is then stored as part of the running configuration. Syntax ntp server {ip-address | hostname} *[key key-number | prefer | version ntp-version] no ntp server {ip-address | hostname} *[key key-number | prefer | version ntp-version]
5-229
prefer ntp-version
ntp source
Sets the source IP address for all transmitted NTP packets to that of a specified interface. The no form of this command removes the specification of a source IP address (default). Syntax ntp source interface-name no ntp source [interface-name] Parameters Parameter interface-name Description {admin 0 | loopback loopback-number | nnet rcp-number | port-chan channelnumber[.subinterface] | pos-chan channelnumber | tunnel tunnel-number}.
ntp trusted-key
Selects the authentication key to be used for authenticating received NTP packets. The no form of this command disables authentication of received NTP packets (default).
5-230
Syntax ntp trusted-key key-number no ntp trusted-key key-number Parameters Parameter key-number Description Authentication key number, range is 1 to 65534.
ntptrace
Displays the route from the RCP to the originating ntp clock source. Syntax ntptrace Mode User EXEC
offline
Specifies what actions should be taken when transitioning from any state to the offline state. Syntax offline command-string Parameters Parameter command-string Description List of commands (separated by semicolons) to be executed in sequence.
5-231
ospf
Enables debug messages of specified OSPF instances (or all instances if none specified) to be placed in the trace file. The no form of this command disables debug messages of specifiedOSPF instances (or all instances if none specified) from being placed in the trace file (default). Syntax ospf [instance-id]... no ospf [instance-id]... Parameters Parameter instance-id Mode Traceoptions Configuration Description OSPF instance identification.
ospf alternative-abr
Enables alternative Area Border Router (ABR) implementation. The no form of this commanddisables this function (default). Syntax ospf alternative-abr no ospf alternative-abr Mode Global Configuration Guidelines With this feature enabled, if the RCP is attached to multiple OSPF areas but does not have afunctional connection to the OSPF backbone area, the RCP will not advertise itself as an ABR. Itwill consider itself an internal router.
ospf area
This is a group of functions that configure OSPF multi-area parameters. Each command has a no form to delete the configured feature. Note: This command will overwrite OSPF instance created using the router ospf command.
5-232
authentication message-digest stub no-summary nssa no-summary Mode Topology map configuration.
ospf-topology-neighbor
To add an OSPF neighbor into the SVP managed topology, use the ospf-topology-neighbor command in topology-map configuration mode. Multiple OSPF neighbors can be specified in topology map. Syntax ospf-topology-neighbor<ifname>area {<ip-address> |<area-id>} ospf-id<ospf-id> no ospf-topology-neighbor<ifname>area {<ip-address> |<area-id>} ospf-id<ospf-id> Parameters Parameter ifname ip-address Description name of the interface area ID in IP address format Type/Range String Default None
5-233
packet
Enables packet routing debug messages to be placed in the trace file. The no form of this command disables packet routing debug messages from being placed in the trace file (default). Syntax packet no packet Mode Traceoptions Configuration
Mode Interface Configuration (Loopback, Port-chan, Pos-chan, Tunnel) Subinterface Configuration (Port-chan)
5-234
passive-interface (OSPF)
Disables the sending of routing updates from the specified interface. The no form of this command re-enables sending of routing updates from the interface. Syntax passive-interface {default | interface-name} no passive-interface [default | interface-name] Parameters Parameter default interface-name Description Disables sending of routing updates from all of the RCPs interfaces. {loopback loopback-number | port-chan channel-number[.subinterface] |pos-chan channel-number | tunnel tunnel-number}.
password-encryption
Enables password encryption for BGP, IS-IS, and OSPF neighbor passwords. The no form of thiscommand disables password encryption (default). Syntax password-encryption no password-encryption Mode Global Configuration Guidelines This command enables or disables encryption for BGP, IS-IS, and OSPF neighbor passwordsonly. Username passwords, privileged mode passwords, and authentication key passwords arealways encrypted.
pcap-enable
5-235
The no form of this command, regardless of parameters, disables the saving of the RTP streams to disk. Syntax pcap-enable [[encrypted] upload-password <upload-password>][scramble] no pcap-enable [[[encrypted] upload-password <upload-password>] [scramble]]
Parameters Parameter encrypted upload-password scramble Mode Global Configure Description The encrypted keyword is used for encrypting the output of the running configuration. The password that must be entered when a request is made to retrieve RTP pcap file from the browser. Scramble wav file before uploading. Default is off.
pdd
The Post Dial Delay (PDD) threshold is the percentage of call sessions with a PDD that exceeds the std-dly or non-std-dly configured. The delays are specified in milliseconds. The system determines which delay to use based on the destination ID of the session. If the prefix of the destination ID is defined in the non-standard list (see session-non-std-dest command), the non-std-dly is used. Otherwise, the std-dly is used. If the percentage of sessions with excessive PDD is greater than or equal to the defined
5-236
Parameters Parameter std-dly Description PDD delay in ms for sessions with default destinations; i.e. not a non-standard prefix. PDD delay in ms for sessions with a nonstandard destination; i.e. a non-standard prefix. set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. If the percentage of sessions with an excessive delay is greater than this value an alarm will be sent. 0-99 Type/Range 0-65535 Default 5000 ms
non-std-dly
0-65535
5000 ms
interval1 interval2
None None
5-237
clear
If the percentage of sessions with an excessive delay is less than or equal to this value the alarm will be cleared.
0-99
none
pdsp
The Packet Drop Session Percentage is the percentage of sessions that ended with an packet drop ratio greater than or equal to the defined threshold. This command specifies the threshold to determine if a session has excessive packet drop and specifies the percentage of such sessions that would trigger an alert to be generated. If the packet drop ratio is specified, then all sessions with an packet drop ratio (PDR) greater than or equal to that value will be marked as having excessive packet drop. Note: a PDR value of 0 is interpreted to mean sessions with a non-zero packet drop count. The command replaces the existing packet drop ratio and/or the settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the PDSP alert for all time intervals and returns the PDR threshold to its default value. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the PDSP alert for that time interval. The no form of the command with the PDR value will return the PDR to its default value. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS. The set threshold must be greater than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax pdsp {[pdr pdr>] [interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } no pdsp {[pdr <pdr>] [interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter pdr interval1 Description Packet Drop Ratio threshold value. set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. Type/Range 0-100 30 None Default
5-238
interval2
set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. If the percentage of sessions with a PDR is greater than this value an alarm will be sent. If the percentage of sessions with a PDR is less than or equal to this value the alarm will be cleared. 0-99
None
clear
0-99
none
peer-address
Enables debug messages of specified peer addresses to be placed in the trace file. The no formof this command disables debug messages of specified peer addresses (or all peer addresses ifnone specified) from being placed in the trace file (default). Syntax peer-address {ip-address}... no peer-address [ip-address]... Parameters Parameter ip-address Mode Traceoptions Configuration Description IP address of peer
permit (extended)
In an extended access-list, sets the conditions under which packets are permitted. The no
5-239
rcp
protocol
ip source-ip-address source-wildmask
5-240
dscp-value
DSCP value to be matched, range is 0 to 63, or a well-known DSCP name, orsymbolname if defined in define dscp. Precedence level to be matched, valid entries are 0 to 7, or a wellknownprecedence name, or symbol-name if defined in define ip-precedence. Service level to be matched, range is 0 to 15, or a well-known ToS name (RCPoption only). Specifies that information about matching packets will be sent to the console. Specifies that the input interface is to be included in the log. Specifies that packets in IP datagram fragments are to be matched (RCP option only).
precedence-value
tos-value
class-map-name
Name of an existing class-map (created with class-map command) to whichthe access-list is being applied.
5-241
icmp-type
ICMP name or code to be matched, range is 0 to 255, or symbol-name may beused if defined in define icmp-code. ICMP subcode to be matched, range is 0 to 255.
icmp-subcode
Mode IP Extended Access-List Configuration Guidelines See the permit (extended) command for other descriptions of inputs that are common betweenthe IP access-list family of commands.
Mode IP Extended Access-List Con figuration Guidelines See the permit (extended) command for other descriptions of inputs that are common betweenthe IP access-list family of commands.
5-242
dest-tcp-port
5-243
TCP flag to be matched (RCP option only). TCP flag to be matched (RCP option only).
See the permit (extended) command for other descriptions of inputs that are common betweenthe IP access-list family of commands.
5-244
source-udp-port
Decimal number or well-known name of the source TCP port, or symbolnameif defined in define udp-port. Decimal number or well-known name of the destination TCP port, or symbolnameif defined in define udp-port.
dest-udp-port
Mode IP Extended Access-List Con figuration Guidelines See the permit (extended) command for other descriptions of inputs that are common betweenthe IP access-list family of commands.
permit (standard)
In a standard access-list, sets the conditions under which packets are permitted. The no formof this command removes a permit condition from the access-list through specification of asequence number and/or matching permit clause. Syntax permit [seq sequence-number] {ip-address [wildmask] | any | host ip-address} [log] no permit {seq sequence-number | [seq sequence-number] {ip-address [wildmask] | any | hostip-address} [log]} Parameters Parameter sequence-number Description Unique sequence number of the permit clause being added or deleted; bydefault, sequence numbers start at 10 and increment by 10 for each entry added to the end ofthe access-list. Access is permitted for all addresses matching the IP address andwildcard mask combination (if wildcard mask is not specified, 0.0.0.0 is assumed). Access is permitted for all IP addresses. Access is permitted for this host IP address. Specifies that information about matching packets will be sent to the console.
ip-address [wildmask]
5-245
plsp
The Packet Loss Session Percentage is the percentage of sessions that ended with an packet loss ratio greater than or equal to the defined threshold. This command specifies the threshold to determine if a session has excessive packet loss and specifies the percentage of such sessions that would trigger an alert to be generated. If the packet loss ratio is specified, then all sessions with an packet loss ratio (PLR) greater than or equal to that value will be marked as having excessive packet loss. Note: a PLR value of zero is interpreted to mean any sessions with a non-zero packet loss count. The command replaces the existing packet loss ratio and/or the settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the PLSP alert for all time intervals and returns the PLR threshold to its default value. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the PLSP alert for that time interval. The no form of the command with the PLR value will return the PLR to its default value. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS. The set threshold must be greater than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax plsp {[plr plr>] [interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } no plsp {[plr <plr>] [interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter plr interval1 interval2 Description Packet Loss Ratio threshold value. set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. Type/Range 0-100 30 None None Default
interval3 interval4
None None
5-246
set
If the percentage of sessions with a PLR is greater than this value an alarm will be sent. If the percentage of sessions with a PLR is less than or equal to this value the alarm will be cleared.
0-99
none
clear
0-99
none
pmosp
The calculation of the session's MOS percentage and the method for session categorization is described in the bmosp command. This command specifies the threshold for determining if the session has a Poor MOS percentage. This command also specifies the ratio of all poor sessions to all sessions with MOS scores calculated. If the calculated ratio is greater than the configured threshold, an alert will be generated. This command replaces the existing PMOS threshold and/or the settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the PMOSP alert for all time intervals and returns the PMOS thresholds to their default value. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the PMOSP alert for that time interval. The no form of the command with the PSMOS value and/or PVMOS will return the threshold to its default value. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS. The set threshold must be greater than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax pmosp {[psmos <psmos>] [pvmos <pvmos>] [interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } no pmosp {[psmos <psmos>] [pvmos <pvmos>] [interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter psmos Description Poor Speech MOS percentage threshold value. Type/Range 0-100 70 Default
5-247
pvmos
Poor Video MOS percentage threshold value. set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. If the percentage of sessions with a poor MOS ratio is greater than this value an alarm will be sent. If the percentage of sessions with a poor MOS ratio is less than or equal to this value the alarm will be cleared.
40-100
70
interval1 interval2
None None
clear
0-99
none
pgmgroup
Specifies a group of programs or commands that can be initiated or terminated as a group. Syntax pgmgroup program-group {program-specification} Parameters Parameter program-group Description Program group name.
5-248
program-specification
[ENV_VARIABLE=VALUE.] [sh | csh | gdb] command-string -f1. arg1.[chdir path] [vnet num] [sigrecovery num] [sigoffline num] [waitexit] [onexit {ignore | restart | fail |stop | returnstatus | recover}] [<stdin][>stdout][>&stderr]. Environment variable settings, VALUE can be a number, name, orstring; the string must begin and end with a quotation-mark character (). Shell specification CShell specification GNU Debugger Specification Command name or pathname and any desired flags or arguments,the command string must begin and end with a quotationmark character (). Pathname used to set the current working directory. Sets the programs vnet number. Signal to be delivered when the RCP enters a recovery state. Signal to be delivered when the RCP enters an offline state. Specifies that the protection monitor program should wait for a program to exit orsend a Program Status message before continuing with other program initiations. Tells the protection monitor program what to do if the program exits. Ignore the exit (default). Restart the program. Assume the program has failed (triggering an RCP switch over if it occurs on an activeprotected RCP). Stop the program. Tells the protection monitor program to switch over if possible, otherwise to restartthe failed program. Standard input, the string must begin and end with a quotation-mark character ().
ENV_VARIABLE=VALUE
stop recover
stdin
5-249
stdout stderr
Standard output, the string must begin and end with a quotation-mark character (). Standard error, the string must begin and end with a quotation-mark character ().
ping (privileged)
Provides advanced network connectivity diagnosis. Syntax ping [{host | ip-address} *[data pattern | interval seconds | numeric | quiet | repeat count | size bytes | source {host | interface-name | ip-address} | sweep min-size max-size interval | time-limit seconds]] Parameters Parameter host ip-address data pattern interval seconds numeric quiet Description Name of the destination host. IP address of the destination host Data pattern, range is 1 to 16 bytes, default is 0xABCD. Interval in seconds to wait before sending each packet, range is 1 to 3600,default is 1. Only numeric addresses are displayed, default is no numeric. Normal output is not displayed except summary lines at startup and completion, defaultis no quiet. Number of ping packets sent to the destination host, range is 1 to 2147483647,default is 5. Size of the ping datagram in bytes, range is 1 to 8184, default is 100. Source name for outgoing packets. Source interface name for outgoing packets.
repeat count
5-250
interface-name
{admin 0 | loopback loopback-number | nnet rcp-number | port-chanchannelnumber[.subinterface] | pos-chan channelnumber | tunnel tunnel-number}. Source address for outgoing packets. Minimum bytes for sweep range, range is 1 to 8184, default is 1. Maximum bytes for sweep range, range is 1 to 8184, default is 8184. Interval value to increment by, default is 1. Time in seconds that a ping exits regardless of the number of packetsreceived, range is 0 to 3600, default is 0 (no time-limit).
source ip-address sweep min-size sweep max-size sweep interval time-limit seconds
If this command is issued without options, the user is prompted with the following fields: Parameter Target IP address: Numeric display [n]: Repeat count [5]: Description IP address of the destination host. Only numeric addresses are displayed, default is no numeric. Number of ping packets sent to the destination host, range is 1 to2147483647, default is 5. Interval in seconds to wait before sending each packet, range is 1 to3600, default is 1. Size of the ping datagram in bytes, range is 1 to 8184, default is 100. Time in seconds that a ping exits regardless of the number ofpackets received, range is 0 to 3600, default is 0 (no time-limit). Source name or address, or interface-name for outgoingpackets. Data pattern, range is 1 to 16 bytes, default is 0xABCD. Datagram size is sequentially varied, default is no sweep range. Minimum bytes for sweep range, range is 1 to 8184, default is 1. Maximum bytes for sweep range, range is 1 to 8184, default is 8184. Interval value to increment by.
Source address or interface: 16-byte data pattern [0xABCD]: Sweep range of sizes [n]: Sweep min size [1]: Sweep max size [8184]: Sweep interval [1]:
5-251
Normal output is not displayed except summary lines at startupand completion, default is no quiet.
Mode Privileged EXEC Guidelines All incoming ICMP Echo Request packets that are addressed to the RCP, and greater than 9000bytes, are dropped in order to protect the RCP from malicious network traffic.
ping (user)
Provides basic network connectivity diagnosis. Syntax ping {host | ip-address} Parameters Parameter host ip-address Mode User EXEC Guidelines All incoming ICMP Echo Request packets that are addressed to the RCP, and greater than 9000bytes, are dropped in order to protect the RCP from malicious network traffic. Description Name of the destination host. IP address of the destination host
5-252
Parameters Parameter maximum-entries Description Number of entries that the address policy cache may contain before oldentries are written over by new entries, default is 20000, range is 0 to 250000.
5-253
privilege level
Assigns a privilege level to a command. The no form of this command assigns a command backto the default privilege level value. Syntax privilege mode level level command no privilege mode [level level command] Parameters Parameter mode Description {address-family | configure | controller | cos-queue-group-in | cos-queuegroupout | exec | flow-cache | interface | ipexplicit-path | ipenacl | ipsnacl | line | path-attr | policy-list | protmon | QoSclassmap | QoSpolicymap-in | QoSpolicymap-out| QoSpolicymapclassin | QoSpolicymapclass-out | route-map | router | subinterface |traceoptions}. address-family configure controller cos-queue-group-in cos-queue-group-out exec Address Family Configuration mode. Global Configuration Mode. Controller Configuration Mode. CoS Queue Group Input Configuration Mode. CoS Queue Group Output Configuration Mode. EXEC mode.
5-254
flow-cache interface ip-explicit-path ipenacl ipsnacl line path-attr policy-list protmon QoSclassmap QoSpolicymap-in QoSpolicymap-out QoSpolicymapclass-in QoSpolicymapclass-out route-map router subinterface traceoptions level level command
Flow Aggregation Cache Configuration Mode. Interface Configuration Mode. IP Explicit Path Configuration Mode. IP Extended Access-List Configuration Mode. IP Standard Access-List Configuration Mode. Line Configuration Mode. Path Attribute Configuration Mode. IP Policy-List Configuration Mode. Protection Monitor Configuration Mode. QoS Class-Map Configuration Mode. QoS Policy-Map Input Configuration Mode. QoS Policy-Map Output Configuration Mode. QoS Policy-Map Class Input Configuration Mode. QoS Policy-Map Class Output Configuration Mode. Route-Map Configuration Mode. Router Configuration Mode. Subinterface Configuration Mode. Traceoptions Configuration Mode. Privilege level, range is 0 to 15. Command that is being assigned a privilege level.
prompt
Enables a custom prompt string to be configured. The no form of this command disables the custom prompt string function, and sets the prompt string to the default value (default). Syntax prompt prompt-string
5-255
no prompt [prompt-string] Parameters Parameter prompt-string Description Custom prompt alphanumeric string plus special string sequences as listedbelow, range is from 1 to 64 alphanumeric characters. If the string contains a space character oris null, the string must begin and end with a quotation-mark character (). Percent sign character (%). Backup RCP indicator (HA-BU: if backup RCP). Hostname. RCP copy number (0 or 1). TTY number. Prompt character. Partition number (0.5 or admin). Space character. Tab character.
The default value for the prompt is equivalent to a %b%h%p custom prompt string.
5-256
pwd
Displays the name of the default file directory. Syntax pwd Mode Privileged EXEC
qos-mib
This command enables the SVP to gather qos information from a router in the monitored network. The command specifies the mib type to poll, how many queues should be monitored and the polling rate. The snmp access command must be configured to allow the qos-mib collection to occur. The default poll interval will be the same as that specified snmp-access command. Syntax qos-mib [mib-type {cisco-class-based-qos | cisco-wrr-qos}] max-queues<max-
5-257
max-queues poll-multiple
queue-bandwidth-utilization thresholds
This command enables the SVP to set an alert if the measured queue utilization divided by the provisioned utilization is greater than a specified percentage. This command only has an effect if the qos-mib command has been configured to enable monitor of qos information from monitored routers. If packet drops are detected or the set threshold is crossed, an alert will be generated. This command allows a different threshold for two queue types: priority and nonpriority. If no threshold is set for a queue type, then no alert is generated. If the no form of the command is entered and no parameters are specified, all thresholds are removed. If a specific queue type is entered, that queue types threshold is r emoved regardless of the value. The priority queue bandwidth alert will set the congestion field of all sessions on the link at the time of the alert. Syntax queue-bandwidth-utilization thresholds {[priority-set <priority-set> priority-clear<priorityclear>] | [non-priority-set <non-priority-set> non-priority-clear<non-priority-clear>] } no queue-bandwidth-utilization thresholds [priority-set <priority-set> priorityclear<priority-clear>] | [non-priority-set <non-priority-set> non-priority-clear<non-priorityclear>]
5-258
1-100
none
radius-server host
Sets a RADIUS server host to be used by the RCP. The no form of this command removes aRADIUS server host. Syntax radius-server host {host | ip-address} *[auth-port udp-port | key [encryption-type] key-value |retransmit retransmit-value | timeout seconds] no radius-server host {host | ip-address} *[auth-port udp-port | key [encryption-type] keyvalue| retransmit retransmit-value | timeout seconds] Parameters Parameter host ip-address udp-port Description Name of RADIUS server host. IP address of RADIUS server host. Udp port number for authentication requests, range is 1 to 65535, default is 1645. Specifies whether the key that follows is encrypted. A value of 0 (default)indicates the following key is not encrypted, and a value of 7 indicates the following key isencrypted.
encryption-type
5-259
key-value
Authentication key value, range is 1 to 8 alpha-numeric-symbolic characters(cannot begin with a # character and spaces are not allowed), default is the value set by theradius-server key command. Number of times a RADIUS request should be resent to the RADIUS serverhost, range is 1 to 100, default is the value set by the radius-server retransmit command. Number of seconds to wait for the RADIUS server host to respond before re-sendinga RADIUS request, range is 1 to 1000, default is the value set by the radius-server timeoutcommand.
retransmit-value
seconds
radius-server key
Sets the authentication key for all RADIUS requests and responses. The no form of this command disables the authentication key. Syntax radius-server key [encryption-type] key-value no radius-server key [[encryption-type] key-value] Parameters Parameter encryption-type Description Specifies whether the key that follows is encrypted. A value of 0 (default)indicates the following key is not encrypted, and a value of 7 indicates the following key isencrypted. Key value, range is 1 to 8 alpha-numericsymbolic characters (cannot begin with a# character and spaces are not allowed).
key-value
5-260
radius-server retransmit
Sets the number of retransmissions to each RADIUS server host. The no form of this commanddisables retransmission. Syntax radius-server retransmit retransmit-value no radius-server retransmit [retransmit-value] Parameters Parameter retransmit-value Description Number of times a RADIUS request should be resent to each RADIUSserver host, range is 1 to 100, default is 3.
radius-server timeout
Sets the duration of time to wait for a RADIUS server host to respond. The no form of this command sets the default. Syntax radius-server timeout seconds no radius-server timeout [seconds] Parameters Parameter seconds Description Number of seconds to wait for a RADIUS server host to respond, range is 1 to 1000,default is 5.
rcp-reboot
Reboot the SV server.
5-261
Parameters Parameter at<hh:mm> in mm now Mode User EXEC Description The time at which to perform the reboot. Reboot the system in mm minutes from now. Reboot the system now.
rcp-shutdown
Shuts the the SV server down and powers it off. Syntax rcp-shutdown {[at<hh:mm>] |[in mm] | [now]}
Parameters Parameter at<hh:mm> in mm now Mode User EXEC Description The time at which to perform the shutdown. Shuts down the system in mm minutes from now. Shutdown the system now.
rcp license-key
This command is used to install or upgrade a SVP license. The no form will remove an existing license. This command is only valid on the SVP. Syntax rcp license-key <key-string>
5-262
[no] rcp license-key <key-string> Parameters Parameter <key-string> Description A string with fixed length of 19 characters, in the format of xxxx-xxxx-xxxx-xxxx
rcp monitor
This command sets the SVA(s) to be monitored by the SVP. The SVA is deployed to add visibility to the media stream associated with sessions the SVP detects via signaling. The no form of command removes the SVA being monitored from the SVP monitor list. If no SVA address is specified, then all the SVAs being monitored will be removed from the SVP monitor list. For proper system operation, both the SVP and the SVPs SVM are required to exchange messages with the SVA. This command provides for different configurations depending on possible NAT issues. In the simplest form, the rcpa-ip-address parameter is the only parameter specified. This indicates that both the SVP and the SVM can use this address to establish communication. The rcpm-rcpa-ip-address parameter is added if the SVM should use a different IP address than the SVP. In this case, the SVP will use the rcpa-ip-address and the SVM will use the rcpmrcpa-ip-address. This intended for the case that the SVP and SVA are behind an IP NAT function. If the SVP and SVA are behind a port address translation function, the SVM must know the public IP address and public ports expected. The rcpm-rcpa-ip-address is used for display on the GUI for the SVA. This address must be unique for all SVAs the SVM will monitor. There are two forms of the port address translation configuration. The first form only specifies the first public port number and the system assumes consecutive port numbers for all the services that are connected. The second form explicitly defines each public port number for each connected service. The no form of the command removes the rcpa-ip-address entered, the remaining parameters are ignored. Syntax rcp monitor rcpa-ip-address <ip-address-string>[rcpm-rcpa-ip-address <rcpm-ip-addressstring>[rcpm-rcpa-public-ip-port<public-ip-string><public-port>| rcpm-rcpa-public-ip-portmap<public-ip-stringr><public-9006-port><public-9008-port><public-9010-port><public-22port>]] no rcp monitor rcpa-ip-address <ip-address-string> [rcpm-rcpa-ip-address <rcpm-ip-
5-263
public-ip-string public-port
rcpm monitor
This command configures the IP address of an SVP to be monitored by SVM. This command provides configuration for reach-ability behind a port address translation function. In this case, a single public IP address is used to access multiple systems and port mapping is used to distinguish the actual destination IP address and port. In this case, the rcpip-address is still used to uniquely identify the SVP on the GUI. There are two forms of the port address translation configuration. The first form only specifies the first public port number and the system assumes consecutive port numbers for all the services that are connected. The second form explicitly defines each public port number for each connected service. The no form of the command removes the rcp-ip-address entered, the remaining parameters are ignored.
5-264
remove
Removes older software base releases that are no longer being used. Syntax remove version major-rel-num.minor-rel-num {active | peer | self | standby} Parameters Parameter Description
5-265
The major and minor portion of a software release number. Removes software on the active RCP. Removes software on the peer RCP. Removes software on this RCP. Removes software on the standby RCP.
rename (EXEC)
Changes the name of a file. Syntax rename from-filename to-filename Parameters Parameter from-filename to-filename Description Old name of the file as [device:][directory/]file. New name of the file as [device:][directory/]file.
Mode Privileged EXEC Guidelines The device argument within a directory-name or filename specification refers to both physicaldevices and logical devices (directory areas). For a complete list of valid device arguments, referto the dir command documentation.
replace
Enables new debug messages to overwrite the trace file. The no form of this command enablesnew debug messages to be appended to the trace file (default). Syntax replace
5-266
resequence access-list
For the given access-list, performs a renumbering of all of the sequence numbers so that they aresequential multiples of 10 (10, 20, 30, 40, 50, and so on). If no access-list is given, all access-listsare resequenced. Syntax resequence access-list [access-list-id] Parameters Parameter access-list-id Description Alphanumeric name string of the access-list to renumber.
Mode Global Configuration Guidelines Access-lists may have sequence-numbers that are not multiples of 10 because the RCP allowssequence numbers to be added or deleted by the user. This command maintains the order of theentries in the access-list, but renumbers them into multiples of 10.
resequence ip access-list
For the given access-list, performs a renumbering of all of the sequence numbers so that they aresequential multiples of 10 (10, 20, 30, 40, 50, and so on). If no access-list is given, all access-listsare resequenced. Syntax resequence ip access-list [access-list-id] Parameters Parameter access-list-id Description Alphanumeric name string of the access-list to renumber.
5-267
Mode Global Configuration Guidelines Access-lists may have sequence-numbers that are not multiples of 10 because the RCP allowssequence numbers to be added or deleted by the user. This command maintains the order of theentries in the access-list, but renumbers them into multiples of 10.
resequence ip community-list
Enables a renumbering of all of the sequence numbers for the given ip community-list so thatthey are sequential multiples of 10 (10, 20, 30, 40, 50, and so on). If no ip community-list is given,all ip community-lists are resequenced. Syntax resequence ip community-list [community-list-id] Parameters
5-268
Parameter community-list-id
Mode Global Configuration Guidelines Access-lists may have sequence-numbers that are not multiples of 10 because the RCP allowssequence numbers to be added or deleted by the user. This command maintains the order of theentries in the access-list, but renumbers them into multiples of 10.
resequence ip extcommunity-list
Enables a renumbering of all of the sequence numbers for the given ip extended communitylistso that they are sequential multiples of 10 (10, 20, 30, 40, 50, and so on). If no ip extendedcommunity-list is given, all ip extended community-lists are resequenced. Syntax resequence ip extcommunity-list [ext-community-list-id] Parameters Parameter ext-community-list-id Description Alphanumeric string identifying the extended community-list torenumber.
Mode Global Configuration Guidelines Access-lists may have sequence-numbers that are not multiples of 10 because the RCP allowssequence numbers to be added or deleted by the user. This command maintains the order of theentries in the access-list, but renumbers them into multiples of 10.
resequence ip prefix-list
Enables a renumbering of all of the sequence numbers for the given ip prefix-list so that they aresequential multiples of 5 (5, 10, 15, 20, 25, and so on). If no ip prefix-list is given, all ip prefix-listsare resequenced. Syntax
5-269
rib
Enables Routing Information Base (RIB) debug messages to be placed in the trace file. The noform of this command disables RIB debug messages from being placed in the trace file (default). Syntax rib no rib Mode Traceoptions Configuration
rmdir
Deletes a file directory. Syntax rmdir directory-name Parameters Parameter directory-name Description Name of the file directory as [device:]directory.
5-270
rollback
Sets the running configuration to the last-saved startup-configuration file or to a specified configuration file. Syntax rollback [filename] Parameters Parameter filename Mode Global Configuration Description Name of configuration file
route-map
Creates a route-map for redistribution or policy routing. The no form of this command removesthe sequence-number specified, or if none is given, deletes the route-map. Syntax route-map route-map-name [permit | deny] [sequence-number] no route-map route-map-name [permit | deny] [sequence-number] Parameters Parameter route-map-name permit Description Name of the route map being defined. Indicates that for all routes or packets that match the match command, the followingset actions apply. Indicates that for all routes or packets that match the match command, the route iseither not redistributed (for redistribution route-maps) or not policy-routed (for policy routingroute-maps).
deny
5-271
sequence-number
Position that this route map takes in a list of route maps of the same name.
Mode Global Configuration Guidelines Routemaps are called by policy routing (filtering) or redistribution commands.
route-table-poll
This command enables the SVP to poll the router's route table via CLI. This capability is intended to be used when peering with the router is not possible; as an example, when EIGRP is used as the IGP. If the eigrp keyword is not included in the command then all routes from the route table with known type are retrieved. If the keyword is included, only EIGRP routes are retrieved. The no form of this command removes polling of the router's route table. NOTE: this command has no affect if the cli-access host command is not enabled. Otherwise, the parameters from that configuration are used. Syntax route-table-poll [eigrp] [ bgp | bgp-multi-path ] noroute-table-poll [eigrp] [ bgp | bgp-multi-path ] Parameters Parameter eigrp bgp bgp-multi-path Description Only extract EIGRP routes for inclusion into the router's DRIB. Only extract BGP routes for inclusion into the router's DRIB. Only extract BGP routes with more than one path into the router's DRIB. This will allow peering via BGP to coexist with handling multi-path entries.
routemap-exit
In a route-map, stops processing of the route-map after evaluation of the current sequencenumberin the route-map as if the route-map had no further entries. The no form of this commanddisables this feature, returning route-map processing to its normal behavior.
5-272
router
To configure router related commands, use the router command in topology-map configuration mode. This command puts CLI in topology-map-router mode which enables topology map router configuration commands to be entered. Syntax router<ip-address> no router<ip-address> Parameters Parameter ip-address Description IP address of the router Type/Range String Default None
router-copsrm
In a large network, multiple SVPs may be required to monitor the routers and perform session to topology tracking. COPS-RM is a COPS-based protocol extension that enables the SVPs to share router interface configuration and request session resource tracking. The SVM acts as relay agent for collecting and distributing router interface configuration as discovered by the SVPs. As sessions are captured, the routing path is inspected to determine if another SVP is monitoring a router involved in the session path. If so, the session information is passed to that SVP for tracking. This extension is not an RFC standard is only supported by the SVP OS. This command puts CLI in config-router mode which enables COPS-RM configuration commands to be entered. The current implementation of COPS-RM only supports RSVP-TE tunnel monitoring.
5-273
router-id
Sets the OSPF router-id. The no form of this command sets the router-id to the default setting,which is the highest IP address on the router, or the loopback interface with the highest IPaddress if a loopback has been set. Syntax router-id ip-address no router-id [ip-address] Parameters Parameter ip-address Mode Router Configuration (OSPF) Description IPv4 or IPv6 IP address of this router.
router bgp
Creates a BGP routing process and enters Router Configuration (BGP). The no form of this command deletes a BGP routing process. Syntax router bgp as-number no router bgp as-number Parameters Parameter as-number Description Autonomous system number (or symbol, if created with define as) to which thisBGP router belongs.
5-274
router ospf
Creates an OSPF routing process and enters Router Configuration (OSPF). The no form of thiscommand deletes an OSPF routing process. Syntax router ospf process-id [rfc1583] no router ospf process-id [rfc1583] Parameters Parameter process-id rfc1583 Description Unique integer representing the routing process. Enables RFC 1583 backward compatibility for the OSPF instance only; this affectsthe cost for aggregate summary LSAs (Type 3) and the choice of path to ASBRs.
routing critical-log
Sets the number of previous file versions to maintain and maximum file size for the routing criticallog. The no form of this command sets the number of previous file versions and maximum filesize to the default values. Syntax routing critical-log files files size megabytes no routing critical-log [files files size megabytes] Parameters Parameter files Description Number of previous file versions maintained, range is 0 to 100, default is 1.
5-275
megabytes
Mode Global Configuration Guidelines The routing critical log is designed to help debug difficult problems by putting a minimum set ofcritical routing information on disk.
rrd
The Registration Request Delay (RRD) threshold is the percentage of registration attempts with an RRD that exceeds the dly configured. The delay is specified in milliseconds. If the percentage of registration requests with excessive RRD is greater than or equal to the defined threshold, the Average Registration Delay (ARD) alert is generated. The command replaces the existing delay values and/or the settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the ARD alert for all time intervals and returns the delay value to its default. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the ARD alert for that time interval. The no form of the command with the dly value will return the setting to its default value. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS. The set threshold must be greater than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax rrd {[dly dly>] [interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } no rrd {[dly dly>] [interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] }
Parameters Parameter sdly interval1 interval2 Description RRD delay in ms. set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. Type/Range 0-65535 Default 5000 ms None None
5-276
set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. If the percentage of requests with an excessive delay is greater than this value an alarm will be sent. If the percentage of requests with an excessive delay is less than or equal to this value the alarm will be cleared. 0-99
clear
0-99
none
rsr
Registration Success Ratio (RSR) is a percentage of registration attempts that are successful. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the RSR alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the RSR alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS based on the Registration Success Ratio. The set threshold must be less than or equal to the clear threshold per time interval. Syntax rsr {[interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } no rsr {[interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter interval1 interval2 Description set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. Type/Range Default None None
5-277
set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. Value of ratio is less than this value, alert will set. Value of ratio is greater than or equal to this value, alert will clear. 00 to 100 where 00 implies off. 00 to 100
None None 00 00
rsvp-te-poll
This command enables polling of the RSVP TE MIB of routers in the monitored routing topology. This polling allows the SVP to discover RSVP TE tunnels that have been manually configured in the network. Each discovered tunnel is monitored as a new session in the network and the end-to-end network path of the session is discovered and monitored as well. The default poll interval will be the same as that specified snmp-access command. Periodic polling allows the SVP to determine when the tunnel path changes. The no form of this command disables polling regardless of the parameters specified. Syntax rsvp-te-mib [version {draft-05 | rfc3812}] [poll-multiple <poll-multiple>] no rsvp-te-mib [version {draft-05 | rfc3812}] [poll-multiple <poll-multiple>] Parameters Parameter version Description Support for Cisco routers using the draft-05 version and Juniper routers using RFC 3812 has been implemented. Number of SNMP poll intervals between qosmib polls. E.g. if snmpaccess poll interval is 90 seconds and this value is 2, the qos-mib will be polled every 180 seconds. Type/Range draft-05 rfc3812 Default draft-05
poll-multiple
1-10
5-278
run
Executes an EXEC Mode command from within a configuration mode. Syntax run Mode All configuration command modes
runspf (OSPF)
Enables forcing a Shortest Path First (SPF) calculation for the specified or current OSPF process. Syntax runspf [run-level] Parameters Parameter run-level Description Specifies which OSPF level to do the SPF calculation for, range is 0 to 3, default is 0. 0 runs the SPF calculation for intra-area, inter-area, and external (all levels). 1 runs the SPF calculation for inter-area only. 2 runs the SPF calculation for transit adjustment. 3 (or higher) runs the calculation for external only. Mode Router Configuration (OSPF)
sccp-cvp-address
5-279
sccp-mtp-address
This command identifies the Media Termination Point (MTP) servers deployed in a Contact Center. The command can be issued multiple times with different IP addresses to identify all such nodes in the network. The no form of this command removes an MTP IP address definition. Syntax sccp-mtp-address <ip-address> no sccp-mtp-address <ip-address> Parameters Parameter ip-address Description IP address of an MTP server. Range 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 Default None
sccp-pstn-address
5-280
security-gateway
This command configures the SVP to capture syslog messages from the SeGW. It is also necessary to configure the security-gateway-settings command to indicate the SeGW vendor. This is necessary since the format of the messages is different. The no form of this command disables capturing syslog messages for the specified interface. Syntax security-gateway [site-identifier <id>] gateway-ip-address <gw-ip-addr> syslog-ip-address <ip-addr> interface <ifname> no security-gateway [site-identifier <id>] gateway-ip-address <gw-ip-addr> syslog-ipaddress <ip-addr> interface <ifname> Parameters Parameter id Description Site ID for a security gateway. Range 1-32 alphanumeric characters Default None
5-281
gw-ip-addr
Public virtual IP address for the security gateway. This is the IP address that the Mobile Stations use to set up the IPSec tunnels. IP address for the syslog server (i.e. destination IP address of syslog messages) Interface name for the interface on the SVP that is used for capturing syslog messages from the security gateway.
0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255
None
ip-addr
None
ifname
None
security-gateway-polling
This command is used to enable/disable the SVP to poll the security gateway for tunnel information. The polling mechanism is vendor specific. To poll the AudioCodes SeGW specify the SNMP information. To poll the Genband SeGW specify the CLI information and indicate whether ssh or telnet should be used. The default ports will be used unless a value is explicitly defined. A secondary set of parameters can be specified if needed for redundancy. Note: The system will only maintain one set of information. The last command entered over writes the previous command. The no form of the command disables the previous security gateway polling regardless of the cli or snmp parameters. Syntax security-gateway-polling site-identifier <site-id>snmp-address <ip-address>[udpport<udp-port> ] version {1 | 2c} community<community-string> [snmp-address <ipaddress> [udp-port<udp-port> ] version {1 |2c} community<community-string> ] interval<polling-interval> security-gateway-polling site-identifier <site-id>cli-address <ip-address> [ port-num <portnum>] username<username>[encrypted]password <password> [access-type {telnet | ssh}] [prompt<prompt-string> [cli-address <ip-address> [ port-num <port-num>] username<username>[encrypted]password <password> [access-type {telnet | ssh}] [prompt<prompt-string> ] interval<polling-interval> no security-gateway-polling site-identifier <site-id> [ snmp-address <ip-address>[udpport<udp-port> ] version {1 | 2c} community<community-string> [snmp-address <ipaddress> [udp-port<udp-port> ] version {1 |2c} community<community-string> ] interval<polling-interval> ] no security-gateway-polling site-identifier <site-id> [ cli-address <ip-address> [ port-num
5-282
Parameters Parameter site-id ip-address udp-port version communitystring port-num Description Character string to uniquely identify a security gateway IP address of a security gateway in the dot format SNMP port number. SNMP version. SNMP community string CLI port number. Overrides the default ssh or telnet port number. Username for CLI access. Password for CLI access Indicate whether telnet or ssh access should be used. Specify the CLI command prompt to expect. Time interval to poll the security gateway 30 300 seconds telnet or ssh 1 or 2c char[32] Range char[64] N/A Default None None 161 None None 22-ssh 23-telnet None None telnet > or # 30 seconds
security-gateway-settings
This command is used to indicate the SeGW vendor. This is currently used to control the parsing for the syslog messages which is vendor specific. If the vendor is not specified correctly, tunnel events will not be recognized. The no form of the command returns the setting to the system default. security-gateway-settings vendor { audiocodes-ncite | genband-s2 } no security-gateway-settings vendor { audiocodes-ncite | genband-s2 }
5-283
send-alert user-email
This command adds or removes a user from the list of e-mail address alert notifications should be sent. By default the list is empty. The e-mail service must be enabled before e-mails will be sent. The no form of the command removes a single user or all users if the e-mail address is omitted. Syntax send-alert user-email<email-address> no send-alert user-email[<email-address>] Parameters Parameter email-address Description E-mail address of the user. The address is of the form username@domain.com. Note the DNS server must be enabled to resolve domain name to an IP address.
send-alert email-test
This command sends a test message to all users configured to receive alert notifications. Syntax send-alert email-test
Mode EXEC
5-284
session-capture
The session-capture command is used to install a session capture filter on a specified SVP interface. The IP address and direction parameters are deprecated and should be omitted. The port numbers are not used unless used depending on the message-filter type. The message filter type determines the port numbers to be used for capturing signaling messages. The no form of the command removes the message filter for the specified interface. A maximum of 12 configuration commands is allowed. message-filter uma unistim h323 sccp sip Port usage Not used, 14001 is assumed. Not used, 5000 is assumed Not used, udp port 1719 assumed and tcp ports greater than 1023 are inspected. Default 2000 assumed. The ingress-port may be used to override the default. Default 5060 assumed. The ingress-port may be used to override default. The egress-port may be used in conjunction with ingress-port to specify 2 port numbers for identifying SIP signaling messages.
Syntax session-capture interface <if-name> [cs-ip-addr <ip-address>] [direction {both | originating | terminating}] [ingress-port <port>] [egress-port <port>] [allow-ip-fragments] message-filter {uma|sip|h323|unistim|sccp [profile-name acc1]} no session-capture interface <if-name> [cs-ip-addr <ip-address>] [direction {both | originating | terminating}] [ingress-port <port>] [egress-port <port>] [allow-ip-fragments] message-filter {uma|sip|h323|unistim|sccp [profile-name acc1]} Parameters Parameter interface <if-name> Description Required parameter, the <if-name> specifies the xyxs interface for tapping on a specific SVP host. The xyxs interfaces are numbered 0 to 3 and are designed to prevent message overload on the SVP. Usage is deprecated and should be omitted. Usage is deprecated and should be omitted. Refer to port usage table above. Refer to port usage table above.
cs-ip-addr <ip-address> direction {both | originating | terminating} ingress-port <port> egress-port <port>
5-285
allow-ip-fragments
By default the monitoring interface will ignore fragmented IP packets. If the allow-ip-fragments keyword is used the interface will reconstruct and process fragmented IP packets. This parameter specifies the network deployed protocol that is used to control session establishment. The profile name usage should be discussed with Netsocket support personnel to meet the deployment criterion. The default profile is selected if not entered.
message-filter profile-name
session-delay-success
The SVP analyses the signaling messages during session setup to determine if the session is established successfully. In general, for a call or video session this is done when the RTP media stream is successfully negotiated. In some cases, it may be possible that a downstream signaling event may cause a session to fail soon after it is established. In this case it may be desirable to postpone the session disposition for some number of seconds. This command is used to specify that delay value. NOTE: this is currently only implemented for SIP deployments. The no form of the command returns the delay to its default configuration. Syntax session-delay-success <delay> no session-delay-success [<delay>] Parameters Parameter delay Description Seconds to delay decision. Range 1-30 2 Default
session-from-id
The session-from-id command is used to specify the signaling message field to use for the session from Id. Currently this field is only applicable to a SIP deployment. The no form of the
5-286
session-ip
To allow for session KPIs to be tracked per GANC, it is necessary to configure the SVP with the destination addresses that will be captured in the packets exchanged between the HS and the GANC. If the HS sends messages with a virtual IP address that is NATd to a physical IP by a load balancer, and the SVP will receive packets with either address, it is necessary to provision both the virtual IP and the physical IPs. Sixteen addresses can be provisioned per GANC. The no form of the command will remove the IP address from the GANC list. The vip keyword should be used to identify which IP addresses are not associated with a physical address.
Syntax session-ip[vip] <ip-address> no session-ip[vip] <ip-address> Parameters Parameter ip-address Description IP address expected to be used as destination of this GANC. Type/Range IP address in dotted notation. Default None
5-287
session-loop-alert link-threshold
To configure the thresholds for session path alerts, to indicate levels of sessions that are currently encountering loops detected at a router interface, use the session-loop-alert linkthresholds command. The no form of the command disables the thresholds and hence no session-loop alerts will be sent. Syntax session-loop-alert link-thresholds {set-threshold <set-threshold> clear-threshold <clearthreshold>} no session-loop-alert link-thresholds [set-threshold <set-threshold> clear-threshold <clear-threshold>] Parameters Parameter set-threshold Description If the number of sessions currently encountering a loop is greater than this value, an alert will be set. If the number of sessions currently encountering a loop is less than or equal to this value the alert will be cleared. Range 1-maximum number of sessions 1- value of setthreshold Default none
clear-threshold
none
session-loop-alert threshold
To configure the thresholds for session path alerts, to indicate levels of sessions that are currently encountering loops use the session-loop-alert thresholds command. The no form of the command disables the thresholds and hence no session-loop alerts will be sent. Syntax session-loop-alert thresholds {set-threshold < 32-bit-integer> clear-threshold < 32-bitinteger>} no session-loop-alert thresholds [set-threshold < 32-bit-integer> clear-threshold < 32-bitinteger>] Parameters Parameter Description Range Default
5-288
set-threshold
If the number of sessions currently encountering a loop is greater than this value an alarm will be sent. If the number of sessions currently encountering a loop is less than or equal to this value the alarm will be cleared.
none
clear-threshold
none
session-non-std-dst prefix
This command is currently used to define a prefix list to identify sessions with a destination that is considered to be non-standard. The term non-standard is purposely vague but typically is used to differentiate international call destinations. The signaling delay threshold commands cdd, pdd, vdd, and vpdd use the prefix list constructed by this command. The prefix value is starts with a number 0 to 9 or a + character. Following the first character, an * or . can be used. The * is used to match any number of subsequent digits. The . can be used to as a place holder to any single digit. As an example: 9. Would match any prefix beginning with 9 followed by 10 digits. +9. Would match any prefix beginning with +9 followed by 10 digits. 9* Would match any prefix beginning with 9 followed by any number of digits. The no form of the command removes a previously defined prefix. Syntax session-non-std-dst prefix <prefix> no session-non-std-dst prefix <prefix> Parameters Parameter prefix Description Sequence of digits or +, *, or . special character. Type/Range 0-9, +, *, or . Default none
5-289
session-noroute-alert link-thresholds
To configure the thresholds for session path alerts, to indicate levels of sessions that are currently finding no route as detected at a specific link, the session-noroute-alert thresholds command. The no form of the command disables the thresholds and hence no session-loop alerts will be sent. Syntax session-noroute-alert link-thresholds {set-threshold <set-threshold> clear-threshold <clear-treshold> } no session-noroute-alert link-thresholds [set-threshold <set-theshold> clear-threshold <clear-threshold>] Parameters Parameter set-threshold Description If the number of sessions currently finding no route is greater than this value an alarm will be sent. If the number of sessions currently finding no route is less than or equal to this value the alarm will be cleared. Range 1-maximum number of sessions 1- value of setthreshold Default none
clear-threshold
none
session-noroute-alert threshold
To configure the thresholds for session path alerts, to indicate levels of sessions that are currently finding no route among the managed routers use the session-noroute-alert thresholds command. The no form of the command disables the thresholds and hence no session-loop alerts will be sent. Syntax session-noroute-alert thresholds {set-threshold <32-bit-integetr> clear-threshold <32-bitintegetr> } no session-noroute-alert thresholds [set-threshold <32-bit-integetr> clear-threshold <32bit-integetr>] Parameters Parameter Description Range Default
5-290
set-threshold
If the number of sessions currently finding no route is greater than this value an alarm will be sent. If the number of sessions currently finding no route is less than or equal to this value the alarm will be cleared.
none
clear-threshold
none
session-pcap-ratio
The SVP saves pcap messages associated with a session in memory while the session is active. If the pcap messages are to be saved, they are written to disk. The system places a memory limit and disk usage limit so that saving the pcap information does not degrade overall system performance. If the pcap ratio is set too high for a system that has a high call rate, the system may drop messages and/or omit saving the information. Likewise, the disk space limit may be reached and older sessions may be deleted. Thus reduced the number of days this information would normally be saved. The no form of the command returns the ratio to its default configuration. Syntax session-pcap-ratio <ratio> no session-pcap-ratio [<ratio>] Parameters Parameter ratio Description Percentage of successful sessions to save pcap information for. Range 1-100 1 Default
session-timeout
The SVP is not part of the control signaling for call establishment. Therefore, it is not guaranteed that the SVP will receive all of the signaling in all cases. As a defensive mechanism, the SVP maintains timers during call setup and call establishment. If the timer expires, the SVP will close the session monitoring state. This command is used to set the
5-291
session-thresholds
To configure SVP session and tunnel thresholds, use the session-thresholds command in global configuration mode. This command puts CLI in session-thresholds mode which enables session threshold configuration commands to be entered. Syntax session-thresholds no session-thresholds Mode Global configuration
session-unstable-alert link-thresholds
To configure the thresholds for session path alerts, to indicate levels of sessions whose routes are currently converging as detected at a specific router interface use the session-unstablealert thresholds command. The no form of the command disables the thresholds and hence no
5-292
clear-threshold
none
session-unstable-alert threshold
To configure the thresholds for session path alerts, to indicate levels of sessions whose routes are currently converging use the session-unstable-alert thresholds command. The no form of the command disables the thresholds and hence no session-unstable alerts will be sent. Syntax session-unstable-alert thresholds {set-threshold <32-bit-integetr> clear-threshold <32-bitintegetr>} no session-unstable-alert thresholds [set-threshold <32-bit-integetr> clear-threshold <32bit-integetr>] Parameters Parameter set-threshold Description If the number of sessions currently undergoing routing convergence is greater than this value an alarm will be sent. Range 1-maximum number of sessions Default none
5-293
clear-threshold
If the number of sessions currently undergoing routing convergence is less than or equal to this value the alarm will be cleared.
1- value of setthreshold
none
set
Specifies a global environment variable and its value. Syntax set variable-name {number | name | string | $name} Parameters Parameter variable-name number name string Description Environment variable to set. Numeric value, maximum value is 4294967295. One-word string of alphabetic characters, maximum number of characters is 1024. Multiple word string of alphabetic characters, maximum number of characters is 1024,the string must begin and end with a quotation-mark character (). Value of a previously set environment variable.
name
set as-path
In a route-map, prepends the specified autonomous system number(s) to the as-path of the matched route. The no form of this command leaves the as-path intact (no modification is made). Syntax set as-path {prepend {as-number}... | tag}
5-294
tag
set automatic-tag
Enables the tag value to be automatically computed for the matched route in a route-map. The noform of this command disables this function. Syntax set automatic-tag no set automatic-tag Mode Route-Map Configuration
set comm-list
Enables communities to be added to the COMMUNITY attribute of matched inbound or outboundroutes in a route-map. The no form of this command disables this command. Syntax set comm-list community-list-id [additive] no set comm-list [community-list-id [additive]] Parameters Parameter Description
5-295
community-list-id
Community list that determines which COMMUNITY values should beadded to the COMMUNITY attribute of matched routes. Adds the COMMUNITY values resulting from the community-list to the alreadyexistingCOMMUNITY attribute of matched routes.
additive
set community
Sets the COMMUNITY attribute of matched prefixes to the specified community in a routemap.The no form of this command deletes the COMMUNITY attribute of matched routes. Syntax set community {{no-export | local-as | no-advertise} | {community-number}...} [additive] no set community {{no-export | local-as | no-advertise} | {community-number}...} [additive] Parameters
5-296
Parameter no-export
Description Send this route only to other subautonomous systems within a confederation,and not to an EBGP peer (systems outside the confederation, or if there is no confederation, anyEBGP peer). Send this route to peers in other subautonomous systems within the localconfederation; do not advertise this route to an external system. Do not advertise this route to any peer (internal or external). Community number; this can be any of the following: a number from 1 to 4294967295; specify a single number or multiple numbers separated bya space. a number in the format n:m, where n and m are integers in the range 0-65535. a community symbol as defined with the define community command; specify a singlesymbol or multiple symbols separated by a space.
local-as
no-advertise community-number
additive
5-297
set extcomm-list
Enables extended communities to be added to the EXTENDED-COMMUNITY attribute of matched inbound or outbound routes in a route-map. The no form of this command disables thiscommand. Syntax set extcomm-list ext-community-list-id [additive] no set extcomm-list [ext-community-list-id [additive]] Parameters Parameter ext-community-list-id Description Extended community list that determines which EXTENDEDCOMMUNITYvalues should be added to the EXTENDEDCOMMUNITY attribute of matchedroutes. Adds the EXTENDED-COMMUNITY values resulting from the extended communitylistto the already-existing EXTENDEDCOMMUNITY attribute of matched routes.
additive
5-298
set extcommunity
Sets the EXTENDED-COMMUNITY attribute of matched prefixes to the specified extended community in a route-map. The no form of this command deletes the EXTENDEDCOMMUNITYattribute of matched routes. Syntax set extcommunity {lbw {as-number:32-bit-value | ip-address:16-bit-value} | opaque 32bitinteger:32-bit-integer} rt {as-number:32-bit-value | ip-address:16-bit-value} | soo {asnumber:32-bit-value | ip-address:16-bit-value} | [additive] no set extcommunity {lbw {as-number:32-bit-value | ip-address:16-bit-value} | opaque 32bitinteger:32-bit-integer | rt {as-number:32-bit-value | ip-address:16-bit-value} | soo {asnumber:32-bit-value | ip-address:16-bit-value} [additive] Parameters Parameter lbw as-number:32-bit-value lbw ip-address:16-bit-value opaque 32-bit-integer:32-bit-integer Description Sets the routes extended community attribute to this LinkBandwidth (lbw) value. Sets the routes extended community attribute to this LinkBandwidth (lbw) value. Sets the routes extended community attribute to theextended community type and value specified by the two 32-bit integers (a raw 64-bit extendedcommunity value is passed into BGP). Sets the routes extended community attribute to this Route Target(rt) value. Sets the routes extended community attribute to this Route Target(rt) value. Sets the routes extended community attribute to this soo value. Sets the routes extended community attribute to this soo value. Adds this community to the already-existing extended community attribute.
5-299
set ip address
Sets the route(s) to be originated (injected) in a route-map. The no form of this command clearsthe route(s) to be injected. Syntax set ip address {access-list-id}... no set ip address [prefix-list-id]... Parameter access-list-id Mode Route-Map Configuration Description Name of access-list to be injected.
5-300
set ip next-hop
Sets the next-hop for matching packets in a route-map. The no form of this command removesthis set entry from the route-map. Syntax set ip next-hop {{ip-address}... | peer-address} no set ip next-hop {{ip-address}... | peer-address} Parameters Parameter ip-address Description IP address of the next-hop for this packet. If the first IP address is down, thefollowing address(es) in the list are tried in the order in which they are listed. For inbound route maps, sets the next hop of matching routes to theneighbors address from which the route was received. For outbound route maps, sets the nexthop of advertised matching routes to this router.
peer-address
set local-preference
Sets a locally significant preference value for matching autonomous system paths, in a routemap.The no form of this command removes this set entry from the route-map. Syntax set local-preference local-preference no set local-preference [local-preference]
5-301
set metric
Sets a metric value for a protocol in a route-map used for redistribution. The no form of this command returns the metric value to its default. Syntax set metric [+ | -] metric-value no set metric [+ | -] [metric-value] Parameters Parameter + metric-value Description Adds the specified metric to the existing metric. Subtracts the specified metric from the existing metric. The metric value to be used for this protocol, range is 0 to 4294967295, defaultis the dynamically-learned metric value.
Mode Route-Map Configuration Guidelines Regardless of the value added or subtracted by using the + or Operators, the metric-value willnot be set to a value outside of the range of 0 to 4294967295. If neither the + nor Is used, theexisting metric-value is simply overwritten by the specified metric-value.
set origin
Sets the BGP origin code for route matches in a route map. The no form of this command
5-302
set tag
Sets a tag value for matching routes in route-map. The no form of this command removes this setentry from the route-map. Syntax set tag tag-value no set tag [tag-value] Parameters Parameter tag-value Description Route tag to be set, range is 0 to 4294967295.
set weight
5-303
show
Since there are several commands in the session thresholds configuration mode, a show command will also be added to display the current running configuration for the commands entered in this mode. This command is intended to be used for validating changes to the session thresholds configuration. The user should verify that the required time intervals are provisioned and that the thresholds related to those time intervals are provisioned per thresholds type. If a time interval is not defined, the no alert during that time interval will be generated. Likewise, if a time interval is provisioned, but a specific alert does not have the set/clear thresholds provisioned, that alert will not be generated. Syntax show Mode Session thresholds configuration
5-304
show (BGP)
Displays information about the current BGP routing instance. Syntax show Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv6 Multicast)
show (global)
Displays the entire running-config.
5-305
show (interface)
Displays the interface configuration portion of the running-config. Syntax show Mode Interface Configuration (Admin, Loopback, NNET, Null, Port-chan, Pos-chan, Tunnel) Subinterface Configuration (Port-chan)
5-306
show (OSPF)
Displays information about the current OSPF routing instance. Syntax show Mode Router Configuration (OSPF)
show (system)
Displays the controller (system) configuration portion of the running-config. Syntax show Mode Controller Configuration (System)
show (traceoptions)
Displays the traceoptions configuration portion of the running-config for the currently specifiedtrace file. Syntax show Mode Traceoptions Configuration
show access-lists
Displays the contents of access-lists used on the RCP. Syntax show access-lists [access-list-id] Parameters Parameter Description
5-308
access-list-id
Name of the access-list to be displayed; if none is entered, the contents of allaccesslists are shown.
Mode User EXEC Output {Standard | Extended} IP access list access-list-id Alphanumeric name string of a standard ORextended access-list. sequence-number Unique sequence number of the deny, permit, or remark clause. {deny | permit | remark string} access is denied for the source and destination addressesspecified OR access is permitted for the source and destination addresses specified OR thestring that follows the remark keyword is a special remark. rcp Optional indicator which specifies that this clause should allow an extended set of optionsonly available on the RCP; therefore, this clause will not be applied on the line card. {protocol | ip} Optional name or number of an internet protocol (RCP option only) OR any IPprotocol. {source-ip-address, wildcard bits source-wildmask | any | host source-ip-address} Accessis denied or permitted for packets originating from this source IP address and wildcard maskcombination OR access is denied or permitted for packets originating from any source IP addressOR access is denied or permitted for packets originating from this source IP address host. {eq | gt | lt | neq | range} Optional indicator which specifies that port must be equal to a valueOR specifies that port must be greater than a value OR specifies that port must be less than avalue OR specifies that port must be not equal to a value OR specifies that port must be within arange of values. {source-tcp-port | source-udp-port} Optional decimal number or well-known name of the sourceTCP or UDP port. {dest-ip-address, wildcard bits dest-wildmask | any | host dest-ip-address} Access is deniedor permitted for packets sent to this destination IP address and wildcard mask combination ORaccess is denied or permitted for packets sent to any destination IP address OR access is deniedor permitted for packets sent to this destination IP address host. {eq | gt | lt | neq | range} Optional indicator which specifies that port must be equal to a valueOR specifies that port must be greater than a value OR specifies that port must be less than avalue OR specifies that port must be not equal to a value OR specifies that port must be within a range of values. {dest-tcp-port | dest-udp-port} Optional decimal number or well-known name of the destinationTCP or UDP port. ack Optional TCP flag to be matched (RCP option only) dscp-value Optional DSCP value to be matched or a well-known DSCP name. established Optional TCP flag to be matched (RCP option only) fin Optional TCP flag to be matched (RCP option only) fragments Optional indicator which specifies that packets in IP datagram fragments are to bematched (RCP option only) icmp-type Optional ICMP name or code to be matched. icmp-subcode Optional ICMP subcode to be matched. igmp-type Optional IGMP protocol name or code to be matched. {log | log-input} Optional indicator which specifies that information about matching packets willbe sent to the console OR specifies that the input interface is to be included in the log.
5-309
show alarms
Displays a list of currently existing alarms. If no entity is specified on input, then alarms for allentities are displayed. Syntax show alarms [channel-type | interface-type [...subinterface] | port-type | rx [signal] | subsystemtype[instance] | system]... Parameters Parameter access-list-id interface-type rx [signal] subsystem-type Mode User EXEC Guidelines The output of a show alarms command is sorted by Severity Level (level 0 first through level 7last) and then by Date&Time (oldest through newest). The Alarm-Description field in the output of the show alarms command does not display any alarm defect qualifier text that may exist for an alarm. This information, contained within parenthesis, can be displayed using the associated show controllers command. Output Date Datestamp (mmdd) of when the alarm occurred. Time Timestamp (in hh:mm:ss) of when the alarm occurred. P Partition (A for Admin partition, an integer 0 to 5 for a router partition) Entity-Name Name of the entity to which the alarm is associated. SL Severity level of the alarm (level 0 through level 7) Description {sts12c | sts192c | sts3c | sts48c}. {port-chan | pos-chan}. Display signal group alarms for the specified slot. {ap | cnet | op | osp | rnet}.
5-310
show aliases
Displays the current command aliases for a specific mode or all modes. Syntax show aliases [mode] Parameters Parameter mode Description {address-family | configure | controller | cos-queue-group-in | cos-queuegroupout | exec | flow-cache | interface | ipexplicit-path | ipenacl | ipsnacl | line |path-attr | policy-list | protmon | QoSclassmap | QoSpolicymap-in | QoSpolicymap-out| QoSpolicymapclassin | QoSpolicymapclass-out | route-map | router | subinterface |traceoptions}. Address Family Configuration Mode. Global Configuration Mode. Controller Configuration Mode. CoS Queue Group Input Configuration Mode. CoS Queue Group Output Configuration Mode. EXEC mode. Flow Aggregation Cache Configuration Mode. Interface Configuration Mode. IP Explicit Path Configuration Mode. IP Extended Access-List Configuration Mode. IP Standard Access-List Configuration Mode. Line Configuration Mode. Path Attribute Configuration Mode.
address-family configure controller cos-queue-group-in cos-queue-group-out exec flow-cache interface ip-explicit-path ipenacl ipsnacl line path-attr
5-311
policy-list protmon QoSclassmap QoSpolicymap-in QoSpolicymap-out QoSpolicymapclass-in QoSpolicymapclass-out route-map router` subinterface traceoptions Mode User EXEC
IP Policy-List Configuration Mode. Protection Monitor Configuration Mode. QoS Class-Map Configuration Mode QoS Policy-Map Input Configuration Mode. QoS Policy-Map Output Configuration Mode. QoS Policy-Map Class Input Configuration Mode. QoS Policy-Map Class Output Configuration Mode. Route-Map Configuration Mode. Router Configuration Mode. Subinterface Configuration Mode. Traceoptions Configuration Mode.
show arp
Displays the entries within the Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) table. Syntax show arp Mode User EXEC Output Protocol Type of protocol. Address IP address. Age (min) Time remaining (in minutes) before entry is removed from ARP table. Hardware Addr MAC address (incomplete indicates that the MAC address could not beresolved) Type Encapsulation type. Interface Interface on which the ARP was received.
show arp-clone
5-312
show as-table
Displays all AS numbers (or specified numbers) and corresponding symbols (created with thedefine as command). Syntax show as-table [as-number | symbol-name] Parameters Parameter as-number Description Number of the autonomous system for which the corresponding defined symbol isto be displayed. Existing as-symbol (created with the define as command) for which thecorresponding as-number is to be displayed, symbols must be alphanumeric text stringsbeginning with an alphabetic character and containing up to 20 characters.
symbol-name
show begin
Displays show command output beginning with the line matched by the regular-expression.
5-313
Syntax show show-object | begin regular-expression Parameters Parameter show-object regular-expression Description Any object of a show command. Regular-expression to be matched to control the result of the search.
Mode User EXEC Guidelines The pipe symbol (|) is part of the command syntax and must be included.
show bgp-global-config
Displays the portion of the running configuration that controls all of BGP (the BGP global configuration commands). Syntax show bgp-global-config Mode User EXEC
show bgp-neighbor-config
Displays the running configuration of the specified peer-group or BGP neighbor. If a peergroupor IP-address is not specified, this command displays all configuration information for BGP peergroupsand neighbors. Syntax show bgp-neighbor-config [peer-group | ip-address] Parameters Parameter Description
5-314
peer-group ip-address
BGP peer-group whose running configuration is to be displayed. Address of the BGP peer whose running configuration is to be displayed.
show bgp-network-config
Displays the BGP network commands subset of the running configuration. Syntax show bgp-network-config Mode User EXEC
show bgp-redistribution-config
Displays the portion of the running configuration that controls redistribution in BGP. Syntax show bgp-redistribution-config Mode User EXEC
show clock
Displays the system clock value. Syntax show clock [detail] Mode User EXEC Guidelines
5-315
show community-table
Displays BGP community numbers and the corresponding symbols (created with the define community command). Syntax show community-table [community-number | symbol-name] Parameters Parameter community-number Description Number of the BGP community for which the corresponding definedsymbol is to be displayed, may be entered as a 32-bit integer, or two 16-bit integers separatedby a colon (AA:NN or NN:AA, where AA is the AS-number and NN is the community number). Existing community-symbol (created with the define community command) forwhich the corresponding community-number is to be displayed, symbols must be alphanumerictext strings beginning with an alphabetic character and containing up to 20 characters.
symbol-name
5-316
show debugging
Displays all of the settings used for debugging. Syntax show debugging Mode User EXEC
show dscp-table
Displays IP Diffserv Code Point (DSCP) numbers and the corresponding symbols (created withthe define dscp command). Syntax show dscp-table [ip-dscp-number | dscp-symbol] Parameters Parameter ip-dscp-number Description number for which the corresponding defined symbol will be displayed,range is 0 to 63.
5-317
dscp-symbol
Existing dscp-symbol (created with the define dscp command) for which thecorresponding DSCP number will be displayed, symbols must be alphanumeric text stringsbeginning with an alphabetic character, range is 1 to 20 characters.
show exclude
Displays show command output excluding the lines matched by the regular-expression. Syntax show show-object| exclude regular-expression Parameters Parameter show-object regular-expression Description Any object of a show command. Regular-expression to match text that is to be excluded in the search.
Mode User EXEC Guidelines The pipe symbol (|) is part of the command syntax and must be included.
show exit-point-map
Displays the current exit point map of a RCP-monitored domain. If a host IP address is provided,the output displays all the exit points of the given router. Syntax show exit-point-map [host-address ip-address] Parameters Parameter Description
5-318
ip-address
IP address, in the format of a.b.c.d, that represents the node-id of a node in thenetwork.
Mode EXEC
show history
Displays the contents of the history buffer. Syntax show history Mode User EXEC Guidelines The most recent commands are shown at the bottom of the show history list.
5-319
show host-login-lockout
Show all hosts that have been locked out or which have a non-zero consecutive login attempt failure. Syntax show host-login-lockout Mode User EXEC
show hosts
Displays IP default domain name(s), lookup style, nameservers, and host table information. Syntax show hosts [host] Parameters Parameter host Mode User EXEC Output Default domain is {not set | domain-name} There is no default domain set OR there is a defaultdomain set. Domain list: domain-name(s) One or more default domain names contained within the domainsearch list (multiple domain names are concatenated by spaces). This line is only present ifname/address lookup currently uses a domain service. Name/address lookup uses {domain service | static mappings} Host name to addressresolution uses a domain service OR static mappings. Name servers are ip-address(es) One or more IP addresses of DNS servers (multiple IPaddresses are concatenated by spaces) Flags {temp | perm | OK | UN} Entry entered by a name server that is removed after TTL hasexpired OR entry entered by a configuration command that is not removed OR entry is valid ORentry is unknown. Age Number of hours since the permanent entry was made. TTL Hours, minutes, and seconds until the temporary entry is removed. Type Type of address (always IP) Address(es) Address(es) of the host device. Description Name of a specific host device.
5-320
show icmp-table
Displays ICMP codes and corresponding symbols (created with the define icmp-code command). Syntax show icmp-table [icmp-code-number | symbol-name] Parameters Parameter icmp-code-number Description ICMP code for which the corresponding defined symbol is to bedisplayed, range is 0 to 255. Existing icmp-symbol (created with the define icmp-code command) for whichthe corresponding ICMP number is to be displayed, symbols must be alphanumeric text stringsbeginning with an alphabetic character and containing up to 20 characters.
symbol-name
show include
5-321
Mode User EXEC Guidelines The pipe symbol (|) is part of the command syntax and must be included.
show installs
Displays RCP software package installation history. Syntax show installs {active | peer | self | standby} Parameters Parameter active peer self standby Description Display installed software history on active RCP. Display installed software history on peer RCP. Display installed software history on this RCP. Display installed software history on standby RCP.
5-322
show interfaces
Displays interface configuration and status information for all interfaces. Syntax show interfaces [brief] Parameters Parameter brief Description Specifies a brief output format is to be used (one line per interface).
Mode User EXEC Guidelines The generic form of the show interfaces command (with no options) provides the same outputas the specific forms of the command, but includes all interfaces. For examples and outputsdescriptions of the generic form, refer to the individual specific forms of the command.
5-323
Mode User EXEC Output entity is {administratively down | down | up} Interface or subinterface is in the administrativelydown state OR interface or subinterface physical connection is operationally failed OR interfaceor subinterface physical connection is operationally good. line protocol is {down | up} Interface or subinterface software handling the line protocol hasdetermined the line to be unusable OR interface or subinterface software handling the lineprotocol has determined the line to be good. Hardware is Loopback This is a loopback interface. Description: string Descriptive text for this interface (only present if string is not null) Internet address is ip-address IP address assigned to this interface. SNMP ifIndex SNMPv2 interface index. Internal Proprietary index number used by the routing protocols to identify a port, for NetSocketuse only. MTU n bytes Maximum transmission unit of the interface. BW kilobits Kbit Bandwidth of the interface. DLY microseconds usec The delay value for an interface or network segment. Speed megabits Mbs mode-duplex - Displays current negotiated state, if interface is up/up. RRX rely/255 Reliability of the interface; given as a percentage where 255/255 equals 100percent. LRX rxload/255 Receive load of the interface; given as a percentage where 255/255 equals100 percent (the load calculation uses the value set by the bandwidth interface configurationcommand) LTX txload/255 Transmit load of the interface; given as a percentage where 255/255 equals100 percent (the load calculation uses the value set by the bandwidth interface configurationcommand) Encapsulation {LOOPBACK} The encapsulation type is LOOPBACK loopback not set (Not Applicable) Last input {time | never} Duration of time in hours, minutes, and seconds as 00:00:00 since thelast packet was received on this interface (if the hours field exceeds 23, then the output formatchanges to include only days and hours as #d#h; if the days field exceeds 6, then the outputformat changes to include only weeks and days as #w#d; asterisks are displayed upon
5-324
5-325
5-326
Mode
5-327
5-328
show ip-protocol-table
Displays the contents of IP access-lists used on the RCP. Syntax show ip access-lists [access-list-id] Parameters Parameter access-list-id Description Name of the IP access-list to be displayed; if none is entered, the contents of allaccesslists are shown.
Mode User EXEC Output {Standard | Extended} IP access list access-list-id Alphanumeric name string of a standard ORextended IP access-list. sequence-number Unique sequence number of the deny, permit, or remark clause. {deny | permit | remark string}- access is denied for the source and destination addressesspecified OR access is permitted for the source and destination addresses specified OR thestring that follows the remark keyword is a special remark. rcp Optional indicator which specifies that this clause should allow an extended set of optionsonly available on the RCP; therefore, this clause will not be applied on the line card. {protocol | ip} Optional name or number of an internet protocol (RCP option only) OR any IPprotocol. {source-ip-address, wildcard bits source-wildmask | any | host source-ip-address} Accessis denied or permitted for packets originating from this source IP address and wildcard maskcombination OR access is denied or permitted for packets originating from any source IP addressOR access is denied or permitted for packets originating from this source IP address host. {eq | gt | lt | neq | range} Optional indicator which specifies that port must be equal to a valueOR specifies that port must be greater than a value OR specifies that port must be less than avalue OR specifies that port must be not equal to a value OR specifies that port must be within a range of values. {source-tcp-port | source-udp-port} Optional decimal number or well-known name of the sourceTCP or UDP port.
5-329
show ip arp
Displays specified entries within the Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) table. Syntax show ip arp [hostname | mac-address | ip-address | interface-type | summary] Parameters Parameter hostname Description Network unique name to be assigned to the router, range is 1 to 63 alphanumericor hyphen characters (the first or last character cannot be a hyphen) 48-bit IEEE MAC address using three 4-digit hex numbers separated by periods(xxxx.xxxx.xxxx).
mac-address
5-330
show ip as-path-access-list
Displays contents of the specified as-path access-list, or if none is specified, displays the contents of all as-path access-lists. Syntax show ip as-path-access-list [as-path-access-list-id] Parameters Parameter as-path-access-list-id Description Alphanumeric string identifying the as-path access list being displayed.
5-331
Displays information about VPNv4 Network Layer Reachability Information (NLRIs). Displays information about VPNv6 NLRIs. Displays information about all VPNv4 or VPNv6 NLRIs. Displays information about all VPNv4 or VPNv6 NLRIs. Specifies route distinguisher. 16-bit integer, range is 0 to 65535. IP address expressed in dotted decimal form (A.B.C.D). Displays information in the FIB about this VPN Routing and Forwarding (VRF)instance specified by an alphanumeric-symbolic name, range is 1 to 40 characters. Displays prefixes in the BGP routing table in ascending order.
sorted
Mode User EXEC Guidelines This command displays all BGP attributes for routes in a format that is friendly for test scripts.
5-332
Displays information about VPNv4 Network Layer Reachability Information (NLRIs). Displays information about VPNv6 NLRIs. Displays information about all VPNv4 or VPNv6 NLRIs. Displays information about all VPNv4 or VPNv6 NLRIs. Specifies route distinguisher. 16-bit integer, range is 0 to 65535. IP address expressed in dotted decimal form (A.B.C.D). Displays information in the FIB about this VPN Routing and Forwarding (VRF)instance specified by an alphanumeric-symbolic name, range is 1 to 40 characters. Displays prefixes in the BGP routing table in ascending order.
sorted
5-333
ip-address/mask-length longer-prefixes
IP4 or IPv6 address and mask length (in bits) of the entry to beshown. Displays routes more specific than the route entered in the ip-address[netmask] or ipaddress/mask-length fields. Displays routes matching ip-address, with a shorter mask thanthe ip-address/masklength specified, but a longer mask than mask-length.
shorter-prefixes mask-length
5-334
vrf-name
Displays information in the FIB about this VPN Routing and Forwarding (VRF)instance specified by an alphanumeric-symbolic name, range is 1 to 40 characters. Displays prefixes in the BGP routing table in ascending order.
sorted
5-335
community-symbol-number
local-as
5-336
Displays entries with the COMMUNITY attribute of no-advertise. Displays entries with the COMMUNITY attribute of no-export. Displays routes that have exactly the community or communities specified (nomore and no less).
5-337
vrf-name
Displays information in the FIB about this VPN Routing and Forwarding (VRF)instance specified by an alphanumeric-symbolic name, range is 1 to 40 characters. Displays prefixes in the BGP routing table in ascending order. String identifying the community-list. Displays routes that have exactly the community or communities specified (nomore and no less) in the community-list.
5-338
ip-address vrf-name
IP address expressed in dotted decimal form (A.B.C.D). Displays information in the FIB about this VPN Routing and Forwarding (VRF)instance specified by an alphanumeric-symbolic name, range is 1 to 40 characters. Displays prefixes in the BGP routing table in ascending order. Displays routes that have exactly the community or communities specified (nomore and no less) in the community-list.
sorted exact-match
5-339
16-bit integer, range is 0 to 65535. IP address expressed in dotted decimal form (A.B.C.D). Displays information in the FIB about this VPN Routing and Forwarding (VRF)instance specified by an alphanumeric-symbolic name, range is 1 to 40 characters. Displays prefixes in the BGP routing table in ascending order. Displays routes with the extended community attribute set to thisLink Bandwidth (lbw) value. Displays routes with the extended community attribute set to thisLink Bandwidth (lbw) value. Displays routes with the extended community attribute setto the extended community type and value specified by the two 32-bit integers (a raw 64-bit extendedcommunity value). Displays routes with the extended community attribute set to thisRoute Target (rt) value. Displays routes with the extended community attribute set to thisRoute Target (rt) value. Displays routes with the extended community attribute set to thissoo value. Displays routes with the extended community attribute set to thissoo value. Displays routes that have exactly the extended community or communities specified(no more and no less).
lbw ip-address:16-bit-value
opaque 32-bit-integer:32-bit-integer
rt as-number:32-bit-value
rt ip-address:16-bit-value
5-340
5-341
sorted as-path-access-list-id
5-342
5-343
shorter-prefixes mask-length
Displays flap-statistics for routes with a longer mask thanmask-length, but shorter than the ip-address/mask-length specified.
5-344
sorted
sorted access-list-id
5-345
sorted regular-expression
5-346
sorted regular-expression
5-347
sorted
5-348
sorted
5-349
sorted
5-350
5-351
received-routes
Displays all accepted and rejected receivedroutes from the specified neighbor.
routes
5-352
vrf-name
Displays information in the FIB about this VPN Routing and Forwarding (VRF)instance specified by an alphanumeric-symbolic name, range is 1 to 40 characters. Displays prefixes in the BGP routing table in ascending order.
sorted
5-353
vrf-name
Displays information in the FIB about this VPN Routing and Forwarding (VRF)instance specified by an alphanumeric-symbolic name, range is 1 to 40 characters. Displays prefixes in the BGP routing table in ascending order. Address of the peer router.
5-354
vrf-name
Displays information in the FIB about this VPN Routing and Forwarding (VRF)instance specified by an alphanumeric-symbolic name, range is 1 to 40 characters. Displays prefixes in the BGP routing table in ascending order. Address of the peer router.
5-355
vrf-name
Displays information in the FIB about this VPN Routing and Forwarding (VRF)instance specified by an alphanumeric-symbolic name, range is 1 to 40 characters. Displays prefixes in the BGP routing table in ascending order. Address of the peer router.
5-356
vrf-name
Displays information in the FIB about this VPN Routing and Forwarding (VRF)instance specified by an alphanumeric-symbolic name, range is 1 to 40 characters. Displays prefixes in the BGP routing table in ascending order. Displays AS-paths that match the regular expression.
sorted as-path-regular-expression
5-357
vrf-name
Displays information in the FIB about this VPN Routing and Forwarding (VRF)instance specified by an alphanumeric-symbolic name, range is 1 to 40 characters. Displays prefixes in the BGP routing table in ascending order. Peer-group about which information is shown. Displays a summary of the status of all peer group members.
5-358
ip-address vrf-name
IP address expressed in dotted decimal form (A.B.C.D). Displays information in the FIB about this VPN Routing and Forwarding (VRF)instance specified by an alphanumeric-symbolic name, range is 1 to 40 characters. Displays prefixes in the BGP routing table in ascending order. The prefix-list about which information is shown.
sorted prefix-list-id
5-359
ip-address vrf-name
IP address expressed in dotted decimal form (A.B.C.D). Displays information in the FIB about this VPN Routing and Forwarding (VRF)instance specified by an alphanumeric-symbolic name, range is 1 to 40 characters. Displays prefixes in the BGP routing table in ascending order. Displays entries exactly matching this string.
5-360
ip-address vrf-name
IP address expressed in dotted decimal form (A.B.C.D). Displays information in the FIB about this VPN Routing and Forwarding (VRF)instance specified by an alphanumeric-symbolic name, range is 1 to 40 characters. Displays prefixes in the BGP routing table in ascending order. Displays entries that match this regular expression.
sorted regular-expression
5-361
ip-address vrf-name
IP address expressed in dotted decimal form (A.B.C.D). Displays information in the FIB about this VPN Routing and Forwarding (VRF)instance specified by an alphanumeric-symbolic name, range is 1 to 40 characters. Displays prefixes in the BGP routing table in ascending order. Name of route-map whose matches are shown.
sorted route-map-name
5-362
ip-address vrf-name
IP address expressed in dotted decimal form (A.B.C.D). Displays information in the FIB about this VPN Routing and Forwarding (VRF)instance specified by an alphanumeric-symbolic name, range is 1 to 40 characters. Displays prefixes in the BGP routing table in ascending order.
sorted
show ip community-list
Displays the contents of IP community-lists used on the RCP. Syntax show ip community-list [community-list-id] Parameters Parameter community-list-id Description Name of the community-list to be displayed; if none is entered, the contentsof all community-lists are shown.
5-363
router-id
None.
Mode EXEC
Mode EXEC
Mode EXEC
5-364
show ip copsrm-log
This command displays COPS-RM activity log. Syntax show ip copsrm-log Mode EXEC
show ip explicit-paths
Displays information about the specified explicit path (or all explicit paths if none is specified). Syntax show ip explicit-paths [name name | identifier number] [detail] Parameters
5-365
Description Alpha-numeric-symbolic value representing a given name to an explicit path. Specifies explicit path by number, range is 1 to 65535. Displays information in long form.
show ip extcommunity-list
Displays the contents of IP extended community-lists used on the RCP. Syntax show ip extcommunity-list [ext-community-list-id] Parameters Parameter ext-community-list-id Description Name of the extended community-list to be displayed; if none isentered, the contents of all extended community-lists are shown.
show ip fib
Displays the next-hops or prefixes in the forwarding information base (FIB) of the RCP. Syntax show ip fib {next-hop [hex-handle] | prefixes [ip-address [netmask] | ip-address/mask-length] |summary} Parameters Parameter next-hop Description Displays information about next-hops in the FIB (in hexadecimal).
5-366
Hexadecimal identifier of the next-hop handle in the FIB to be displayed. Displays information about prefixes in the FIB, including their next-hop handles. Displays information about this prefix in the FIB. Displays information about this prefix in the FIB. Displays summary information about prefixes in the FIB.
show ip interface
Displays IP information for a specific interface or for all interfaces. Syntax show ip interface *[brief | interface-name] Parameters Parameter brief interface-name Description Displays only a subset of IP information. {admin 0 | loopback loopback-number | nnet rcp-number | null 0 | portchanchannel-number[.subinterface] | pos-chan channel-number | tunnel tunnelnumber}.
show ip nat
Displays the IP NAT rules configured and associated packet hit counts. NAT rules are bidirectional. The packet counters are the sum of the packets in both directions. Syntax show ip nat [statistics]
5-367
show ip ospf
Displays information about the OSPF instance specified. If no OSPF instance-id is given, information for all OSPF instances on the RCP is given. Syntax show ip ospf [process-id [area-id]] Parameters Parameter process-id Description ID of the OSPF routing process on this router for which information is beingshown, range is 1 to 65535; if no process-id is given, information for all OSPF processes isshown. IP address or integer representing an area for which information is being shown, if noarea-id is given, information for all OSPF areas are shown.
area-id
5-368
Parameter process-id
Description ID of the OSPF routing process on this router for which information is beingshown, range is 1 to 65535; if no process-id is given, information for all OSPF processes isshown.
5-369
process-id
ID of the OSPF routing process on this router for which information is beingshown, range is 1 to 65535; if no process-id is given, information for all OSPF processes isshown. IP address or integer representing an area defined in the network area commandwhose LSAs will be displayed, if none is given, LSAs for all areas are shown. Displays information about all Type 4 (ASBR Summary) LSAs. Displays information about Type 8 (External Attributes) LSAs. Displays information about Type 1 (router) LSAs. Displays information about Type 2 (Network) LSAs. Displays information about Type 7 (NSSA External) LSAs. Displays information about Type 10 LSAs (LSAs that are limited to a particular OSPF area).
area-id
opaque-as
Displays information about Type 11 LSAs (LSAs that are propagated throughout the AS).
opaque-link
Displays information about Type 9 LSAs (LSAs that are limited to a particular network segment).
summary lsid
Displays information about Type 3 (Network Summary) LSAs. Displays information only about LSA with this link-state ID, which must be entered as adotted-decimal IP address. Lists the LSAs in the LSA database by type and displays counts of eachtype.
database-summary
5-370
area-id
interface-name
area-id
5-371
link
Provides detailed information about the links over which traffic engineering is supportedon the local router. Provides detailed information about the traffic engineering fragments on the localrouter.
fragment
Mode User EXEC Output OSPF Router with ID Router ID number. Process ID OSPF process ID Area instance Number of times TE information or any link changed. Link instance Number of times any link changed. Link ID Link-state ID Interface Address Local IP address assigned to the link. Neighbor Address IP address that is on the remote end of the link. Admin Metric TE link metric. Maximum Bandwidth Bandwidth (in kbps) configured for the physical interface. Maximum Reservable Bandwidth Bandwidth (in kbps) configured for TE (through ip rsvpbandwidth) on this link. Number of Priority Number of supported preemption priorities. Priority Bandwidth (in kbps) available for TE at this priority. Affinity Bit Affinity bits assigned to the link.
5-372
area-id
IP address or integer representing an area defined in the network area commandwhose LSAs will be displayed, if none is given, LSAs for all areas are shown. {loopback loopback-number | port-chan channel-number[.subinterface] |pos-chan channel-number | tunnel tunnel-number}. Router-id of the neighbor for which information is displayed. Displays additional detail about the neighbor.
interface-name
router-id detail
5-373
area-id
interface-name
router-id
5-374
Syntax show ip ospf [process-id [area-id]] retransmission-list [interface-name] [router-id] Parameters Parameter process-id Description ID of the OSPF routing process on this router for which information is beingshown, range is 1 to 65535; if no process-id is given, information for all OSPF processes isshown. IP address or integer representing an area defined in the network area commandwhose LSAs will be displayed, if none is given, LSAs for all areas are shown. {loopback loopback-number | port-chan channel-number[.subinterface] |pos-chan channel-number | tunnel tunnel-number}. Router-id of the neighbor for which information is displayed.
area-id
interface-name
router-id
5-375
Mode User EXEC Guidelines The spf-log entries command determines the number of records that are kept in the OSPF spflog.The default is 20.
5-376
Parameters Parameter process-id Description ID of the OSPF routing process on this router for which information is beingshown, range is 1 to 65535; if no process-id is given, information for all OSPF processes isshown.
show ip policy-list
Displays the contents of one or all policy-lists. Syntax show ip policy-list [policy-list-name] Parameters Parameter Description
5-377
show ip prefix-list
Displays the contents of prefix-lists on the RCP. Syntax show ip prefix-list [prefix-list-id [{ip-address/mask-length | ip-address} [longer | first-match] |seq sequence-number] | detail [prefix-list-id] | summary [prefix-list-id]] Parameters Parameter prefix-list-id ip-address/mask-length Description The name of the prefix list whose information is being displayed. Displays entries in the prefix-list with this IP address and netmask length. ip-address longer first-match seq sequence-number summary prefix-list-id Displays entries in the prefix-list with this IP address. Displays entries in the prefix-list with netmask lengths longer than mask-length. Displays the first entry in the prefix-list that matches mask-length. Displays the prefix-list entry with this sequence number. Displays summary information only about all prefix-lists or about thegiven (optional) prefix-list-id. Displays detailed information about all prefix-lists or about the given (optional) prefixlist-id.
detail
show ip protocols
5-378
show ip rib
Displays all routes in the routing information base (RIB). Syntax show ip rib [{ip-address ip-netmask | ip-address/mask-length} [detail] [longer-prefixes] | bgp[as-number] | connected | hash-distribution | interfaces interface-name | isis [isis-tag] |monitored routes [ip-address ip-netmask | ip-address/mask-length] | ospf [instance-id] | static| track next-hop [ip-address ip-netmask | ip-address/mask-length]] Parameters Parameter ip-address ip-netmask ip-address/mask-length detail longer-prefixes Description Displays information for this prefix in the RIB. Displays information about this prefix in the RIB. Displays the route monitoring information along with the route. Displays routes more specific than the route entered in the ip-address [netmask] or ip-address/mask-length fields. bgp [as-number] Displays all routes derived from BGP, and optionally, the autonomoussystem to which the BGP router belongs, if no as-number is specified, all BGP-derived routesare displayed. Displays connected routes.
connected
5-379
Displays route hash table distribution in RIB. {admin 0 | loopback loopback-number | null 0 | port-chanchannelnumber[.subinterface] | pos-chan channelnumber | tunnel tunnel-number}. Displays all routes derived from ISIS, and optionally, those derived from thegiven ISIS routing process, if no isis-tag is specified, all ISIS-derived routes are displayed. Displays monitored routes in the RIB. Displays all routes derived from OSPF, and optionally, those derived fromthe given OSPF process, if no instance-id is specified, all OSPF-derived routes are displayed. Displays static routes. Displays tracking next-hops in the RIB.
isis [isis-tag]
show ip route
Displays active routes in the routing information base (RIB). Syntax show ip route [{ip-address ip-netmask | ip-address/mask-length} [longer-prefixes | detail] | bgp [as-number] | connected | isis [null | isis-tag] | list access-list-id | ospf [process-id] | static | supernets-only | summary] Parameters Parameter ip-address ip-netmask longer-prefixes Description Displays route information for this address. Subnet mask of the address for which information is being shown. Displays routes more specific than the route entered in the ip-address ipnetmaskor ipaddress/mask-length fields. Displays route information in detail.
detail
5-380
bgp [as-number]
Displays active routes derived from BGP, and optionally, the autonomoussystem to which the BGP router belongs, if no asnumber is specified, all BGP-derived routes are displayed.
Displays connected routes. Displays active routes derived from ISIS null instance. Displays active routes derived from ISIS, and optionally, those derived from thegiven ISIS routing process, if no isis-tag is specified, all ISIS-derived routes are displayed. Displays routes matching this access list. Displays active routes derived from OSPF, and optionally, those derivedfrom the given OSPF process, if no process-id is specified, all OSPF-derived routes aredisplayed. Displays static routes. Displays distribution of prefix lengths in active table. Displays information for active supernets in the RIB. Displays summary-level information for active routes in the RIB.
show ip rpf
Displays information about Reverse Path Forwarding (RPF) for the specified IPv4 multicast soource address. Syntax show ip rpf ip-address [metric] Parameters Parameter ip-address metric Description Displays RPF information about this IPv4 multicast source address. Displays metric information for the RPF route.
5-382
Syntax show ip rsvp refresh [tunnel-id tunnel-id] [instance-id instance-number] [source sourceaddress][destination destination-address] [detail] Parameters Parameter tunnel-id instance-id source-ip-address destination-ip-address detail Mode User EXEC Description Specified tunnel interface name or number, range is 0 to 4294967294. Tunnel instance number, range is 0 to 429496295. IP version 4 protocol source address of the RSVP ingress node. IP version 4 protocol destination address of the RSVP egress node. Displays additional statistics information.
show ip ssh
Displays configuration and version information for the SSH (Secure Shell) service. Syntax show ip ssh Mode User EXEC Guidelines SSH software is always enabled on the RCP.
show ip udp
Displays the active UDP responders. Syntax show ip udp responder port port-identifier *[ip-address | | output-modifier regular-expression]
5-383
Parameters Parameter port-identifier ip-address output-modifier Description Port number or port symbol, port number range is 1 to 65535. IP address of the port. Display line based on its context, choices are begin of line, exclude line, orinclude line to be used in conjunction with regularexpression. Regular-expression to match text that is to be identified in the search.
regular-expression
Mode User EXEC Guidelines The pipe symbol (|) is part of the command syntax and must be included.
5-384
system_id
show line
Displays terminal persistent configuration and status. Syntax show line Mode User EXEC
5-385
5-386
end-time
Mode EXEC
show logging
Displays the contents of a log file or the SNMP history table. If no options are supplied, a loggingstatus summary is displayed. Syntax show logging [log-filename | history] Parameters Parameter log-filename history Mode User EXEC Guidelines All alarms declared with a severity level of 7 (debug) are not logged by syslog. These alarmscan only be seen while they are active through use of the show alarms and show controllerscommands. Description Display the specified log file. Display the SNMP history table.
5-387
Output Syslog logging: {disabled | enabled} Syslog logging is currently disabled OR enabled. Console logging: {disabled | level severity-level-name} Debug output and system errormessages are not displayed on the console OR messages equal or higher in priority than thegiven severity level name will be displayed on the console. Monitor logging: {disabled | level severity-level-name} Debug output and system errormessages are not displayed on the lines OR messages equal or higher in priority than the givenseverity level name will be displayed on the lines. Trap logging: {disabled | level severity-level-name} Debug output and system error messagesare not sent to remote syslog servers OR messages equal or higher in priority than the givenseverity level name will be sent to remote syslog servers. Logging to host Host name (or IP address) of remote syslog server. Syslog History Table: n maximum table entries Maximum number of messages to keep inhistory table. saving level severity-level-name or higher Debug output and system error messages equal orhigher in priority than the given severity level name will be stored in history table. n messages ignored, Number of messages not processed. n dropped Number of messages not processed due to lack of resources. n table entries flushed Number of messages removed from the history table to allow logging ofnew messages. SNMP notifications {not enabled | enabled} SNMP traps are not sent to the SNMP server ORSNMP traps are sent to the SNMP server. entry number Entry number of the message within the history table. timestamp: Time since system startup (in seconds) that the event occurred.
process
5-388
total
Displays all memory ever allocated by DRP. This is used to determine which classes ofmemory are the most active in terms of allocations/deallocations.
Mode User EXEC Output remote IP address of remote peer. local IP address of local interface. st Stratum number, range is 0 to 15. poll Polling interval in seconds. reach Reachability register of peer in octal format. delay Estimated delay to peer. offset Offset between system clock and peers clock. disp Dispersion of the peer. hmode Host mode. pmode Peer mode. stratum Stratum number of system clock. precision Precision of system clock. leap Leap second indicator. refid Reference clock identifier. rootdistance Total delay along the path to the root clock. rootdispersion Path dispersion to root. ppoll Peer poll interval in seconds as a power of 2, for example, a value of 5 equals 25seconds. hpoll Host poll interval in seconds as a power of 2, for example, a value of 5 equals 25seconds. keyid Key identifier.
5-389
5-390
5-391
Parameter as-path-access-list-id
5-392
Mode User EXEC Guidelines This command lists out the route-maps that use the policy-list and the protocols that use the route-maps that use the policy-list.
5-393
show privilege
Displays the current level of privilege. Syntax show privilege Mode User EXEC
5-394
Guidelines The output of this command is created internally by performing a UNIX ps command with certainoptions. The UNIX command is ps -co pid,time,start,pri,cpu,%cpu,tt,command. Output PID Process ID. TIME Amount of time process has used CPU. STARTED Time the process started. PRI Priority of the process. CPU CPU usage. %CPU Percent of CPU usage. TT Control terminal name. COMMAND Process name.
5-395
Syntax show rcm discovery [{brief | router <ip-address> | cef | vrrp | ip-to-dn { status | data }}] Parameter brief router<ip-address> cef vrrp ip-to-dn status ip-to-dn data Description Provide a brief summary of router information acquired via polling. The routers IP address in A.B.C.D format to display. Display information collected from polling cef information. Display information collected from polling vrrp and hsrp information. Display status of the last ip-to-dn poll. Display the ip-to-dn entries retrieved during the last poll. If the status indicates a failure, then no entries were retrieved.
Mode EXEC
show rcpalerts
To display SVP system wide topology alert information, use show rcp alerts EXEC command. Syntax show rcp alerts [start-time <start-time>] [end-time <end-time>] Parameters Parameter start-time <start-time> end-time <end-time> Description [Optional] The starting time of the period when the alerts were set. [Optional] The end time of the period when the alerts were set.
Mode EXEC
5-396
end-time
Mode EXEC
5-397
show route-map
Displays the configured route-maps.
Syntax show route-map [route-map-name] Parameters Parameter route-map-name Description Route-map to be displayed, if none is given, all route-maps are shown.
show running-config
NetSocket, Inc. - Proprietary and Confidential 5-398
community-list [community-list-id]
flow-cache
interface [interface-name]
policy-list [policy-list-name]
5-399
policy-map [policy-map-name]
Displays the part of the configuration containing this policymap, or, if none is specified, displays all policy maps in the configuration. Displays the part of the configuration containing this prefix-list, or, ifnone is specified, displays all prefix-lists in the configuration. Displays the part of the configuration containing this routemap,or, if none is specified, displays all route-maps in the configuration. Displays the part of the configuration containing static routes. Displays the part of the configuration containing traceoptionsfor a specified trace file, or all trace files if trace-filename is not specified.
prefix-list [prefix-list-id]
route-map [route-map-name]
show sessions
To display active and terminated session information, use the show sessions EXEC command. Syntax show sessions [{ current [detail]}|{session-id <session-id> [detail]} | { [{[start-time <yyyy:mm:dd:hh:mm:ss>] [end-time <yyyy:mm:dd:hh:mm:ss>] [source-addr <ipaddress>[<ip-netmask>]] [destination-addr <ip-address> [<ip-netmask>]] [tunnel-id <tunnelid-str>] [termination-reason { normal | authorization-fail | timeout-fail | other-failures | anyfailure}] [event-type { link-congestion | link-down | routing-loop | no-route | path-change | anyevent }] [session-type { ipsec | call | data | register | monitor-path }] [from-id <from-id>] [to-id <to-id>] [detail] }]}|{ summary}] Parameters Parameter session-id <session-id> start-time <start-time> end-time <end-time> Description Display session record for specified session Identifier. [Optional] start time for the period when session terminates. This is in the form of yyyy:mm:dd:hh:mm:ss [Optional] end time for the period when session terminates. This is in the form of yyyy:mm:dd:hh:mm:ss
5-400
source-address <src-ipaddress> [<src-ip-mask>] destination-address <dest-ipaddress> [<dest-ip-mask>] detail tunnel-id <tunnel-id-str> Mode EXEC
[Optional] Sessions that have the specified source IP address/network. [Optional] Sessions that have the specified destination IP address/network. [Optional] Display detailed session information,. [Optional] A IPSec tunnel ID in string format
end-time
Mode EXEC
5-401
show snmp
Displays SNMP communications status. Syntax show snmp Mode User EXEC Output Chassis Chassis ID string. Contact Contact string. Location Location string. SNMP packets input Count of SNMP packets input. Bad SNMP version errors Count of packets with an incompatible SNMP version. Unknown community name Count of packets with an unknown community name. Illegal operation for community name supplied Count of packets that requested an operationthat is is not allowed for the supplied community name. Encoding errors Count of improperly-encoded packets. Number of requested variables Count of requested variables by SNMP managers. Number of altered variables Count of altered variables by SNMP managers. Get-request PDUs Count of get requests. Get-next PDUs Count of get-next requests. Set-request PDUs Count of set requests. SNMP packets output Count of SNMP packets output. Too big errors Count of packets larger than the maximum packet size. Maximum packet size Maximum SNMP packet size. No such name errors Count of SNMP requests for which a MIB object does not exist. Bad values errors Count of SNMP requests that contain an invalid value for a MIB object. General errors Count of SNMP requests that failed for another reason other than the No suchname or Bad values errors. Response PDUs Count of responses sent from SNMP requests. Trap PDUs Count of SNMP traps.
5-402
5-403
show (system)
Displays the controller (system) configuration portion of the running-config. Syntax show Mode Controller Configuration (System)
show tcp-port-table
Displays TCP ports and corresponding symbols (created with the define tcp-port command). Syntax show tcp-port-table [tcp-port | symbol-name] Parameters Parameter Description
5-404
tcp-port
TCP port number for which the corresponding defined symbol is to be displayed. Existing tcp-symbol (created with the define tcp-port command) for which thecorresponding TCP port number is to be displayed, symbols must be alphanumeric text stringsbeginning with an alphabetic character and containing up to 20 characters.
symbol-name
show terminal
Displays terminal current configuration and status. Syntax show terminal Mode User EXEC Guidelines Terminal configuration values can be configured in two manners: 1) temporarily (for the durationof the session) using terminal commands; or 2) persistently using equivalent commands withinthe Line Configuration Mode. The current set of configuration values show up in the showterminal command, and the persistent set of configuration values show up in the show linecommand. Output Length: number Number of lines displayed per page on the terminal (configurable with the terminal length and length commands) Width: number Number of columns displayed on the terminal (configurable with the terminal width and width commands) Status: {Active | Connected | Echo Off | Idle Timeout | Input Stopped | Rcvd BREAK | Rcvd CR | Ready | Sent XOFF} A process is currently active on this line AND/OR at least one active connection is currently on this line AND/OR no echoing is being done of what the user inputs on this line AND/OR an idle timeout has occurred on this line AND/OR input stopped on this line due to hardware flow control or overflow AND/OR a BREAK sequence has been received on this line AND/OR last character entered was a carriage return AND/OR state of this line is ready AND/ OR an XOFF character was sent on this line. Capabilities: {none | Enabled | No Login Banner | Receives Logging Output} There are no special capabilities currently configured OR user has enabled into a higher privilege level AND/
5-405
Mode EXEC
Syntax show topology interfaces [drib <drib-name>] Parameters Parameter drib-name Description [Optional] A string consists of the character v followed by the host IP address of the target router.
Mode
5-406
5-407
5-408
show trace
Displays the contents of a trace file. Syntax show trace trace-filename Parameters Parameter trace-filename Mode User EXEC Description Filename of the trace file.
show udp-port-table
Displays UDP ports and corresponding symbols (created with the define udp-port command). Syntax show udp-port-table [udp-port | symbol-name]
5-409
symbol-name
show users
Displays information about the users that are currently logged in. An asterisk (*) at the beginningof an output line denotes the current users information. Syntax show users [me | partition {admin | all | hostname | partition-number}] Parameters Parameter me partition Description Displays information about the current user only. Displays information about users within a specified partition or all partitions.
Mode User EXEC Guidelines The output of this command displays users logged into the RCP where the command is executed.To see the users logged in to the standby RCP, this command must be executed from thestandby RCP. Output Partition Partition number of the user.
5-410
show version
Displays high level software and hardware configuration information. Syntax show version Mode User EXEC
show vlan
Displays configuration and status information about a specific VLAN. If a VLAN identifier is notspecified, then information about all VLANs is displayed. Syntax show vlan [vlan-id] Parameters Parameter vlan-id Mode User EXEC Description VLAN identifier, range is 1 to 4094.
shutdown (interface)
Disables an interface and places it in the Administratively Down state (default). The no form ofthis command enables an interface and releases it from the Administratively Down state. Syntax shutdown
5-411
site-alert-summary
Replaces the system default threshold that determines when lower level site alerts are replaced by a single alert declared against the parent site. The no form of this command regardless of threshold value returns the system to the default threshold. Syntax site-alert-summary threshold <threshold> no site-alert-summary threshold <threshold>
Parameters Parameter Threshold Description If the number of level 2 or level 3 sites with an alert type is greater than or equal to the number of sites derived from this threshold, then the level 2 or level 3 site alerts are replaced with a level 1 or level 2 alert respectively. Type/Range 30-100 90 Default
Mode session-thresholds
skey
Creates an skey (one-time password) for the specified user on the self rcp, peer rcp, or both if notspecified. The no form of this command deletes the skey for the specified user. Syntax skey username [peer-rcp | self-rcp] no skey username [peer-rcp | self-rcp]
5-412
snmp-access host
To configure SNMP related information so that SVP can communicate with SNMP running on the router defined by the router command, use the snmp-access host command. The no form of this command only requires the ip-address parameter. Syntax snmp-access host <ip-address> [udp-port <port>] version {{1| 2c} [encrypted] {community <community-string>} | {3 [encrypted] [auth {md5|sha} <auth-password> [priv des56 <privpassword>]] user <username>} } [interval <value>] no snmp-access host <ip-address>[[udp-port <port>] version {{1| 2c} [encrypted] {community <community-string>} | {3 [encrypted] [auth {md5|sha} <auth-password> [priv des56 <priv-password>]] user <username>} } [interval <value>]] Parameters Parameter ip-address udp-port <port> version 1 2c 3 community <communitystring> Description IP address of the SNMP host. This address does not have to match with routers IP address. [optional] Specifies the port on which SNMP is listening to. Specifies SNMP version SNMP version 1 SNMP version 2c SNMP version 3 Specifies the SNMP community string. The encrypted keyword occurring prior to the community string is generated by the system to avoid showing clear text in the running configuration.
5-413
encrypted
[Optional] Indicates that the entered community string is encrypted. When the snmp-access command is first entered the encrypted keyword is not used and the community string is entered in clear text. The SVP will encrypt the community string and the command will be displayed in the running config with the encrypted keyword. [Optional] SNMP version 3 AuthNoPriv security model. Provides authentication based on the HMAC-MD5 or HMACSHA algorithms. Use MD5 algorithm. Use SHA algorithm. Auth password. [Optional] SNMP version 3 AuthPriv security model. Provides authentication based on the HMAC-MD5 or HMACSHA algorithms. Provides DES 56-bit encryption in addition to authentication based on the CBC-DES (DES-56) standard. Priv password Name of the user. [Optional] Query interval in seconds. Default is 60 seconds.
auth
priv-password user <username> interval <interval> Mode Topology map router configuration
snmp-poll host
In some cases, the SVP must gather information from a host using a proprietary MIB. This command enables this type of polling. Currently this capability is implemented for gathering bandwidth utilization for GPRS services from a GANC. The no form of this command stops SNMP polling. Syntax snmp-poll host <ip-address> [udp-port <port>] version {1| 2c} community <communitystring> vendor-id { kineto } [interval <value>] no snmp-poll host [<ip-address> [udp-port <port>] version {1| 2c} community <communitystring> vendor-id { kineto } [interval <value>]] Parameters Parameter Description Type/Range Default
5-414
ip-address
None
UDP port agent is listening on. Specifies SNMP version Specifies SNMP community string. Designation of vendor that published proprietary MIB. Query interval in seconds.
161
None
60
snmp-server
Enables Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) agent operation. If no SNMP version isspecified, then all SNMP versions are assumed. The no form of this command disables SNMPagent operation (default). Syntax snmp-server [v1 | v2c | v3] no snmp-server [v1 | v2c | v3] Parameter v1 v2c v3 Mode Global Configuration Description SNMP version 1. SNMP version 2c SNMP version 3
snmp-server accesshost
Sets a specified host (only) to access the snmp agent. The no form of this command disablesSNMP agent host operation (default). Syntax snmp-server accesshost {host | ip-address}
5-415
snmp-server chassis-id
Sets the system serial number string. The no form of this command sets the default system serialnumber string (default). Syntax snmp-server chassis-id string no snmp-server chassis-id [string] Parameters Parameter string Description System serial number string, range is 0 to 16 alpha-numeric-symbolic characters.
snmp-server community
Sets the community access string to permit SNMP access. The no form of this command removes the community access string information. Syntax snmp-server community string [view view-name] [ro | rw] no snmp-server community string [view view-name] [ro | rw]
5-416
Parameters Parameter string view-name ro rw Mode Global Configuration Description String to allow SNMP access, range is 0 to 127 alpha-numeric-symbolic characters. Name of the view, range is 1 to 32 alphanumeric-symbolic characters. Indicates read-only access (default). Indicates read and write access.
snmp-server contact
Sets the system contact (sysContact) string. The no form of this command removes the systemcontact string (default). Syntax snmp-server contact string no snmp-server contact [string] Parameters Parameter string Description System contact string, range is 0 to 255 alpha-numeric-symbolic characters.
5-417
snmp-server engineID
Sets the name of the SNMP engine on the RCP. The no form of this command removes the name of the SNMP engine on the RCP. Syntax snmp-server engineID engineid-string no snmp-server engineID [engineid-string] Parameter engineid-string Description ASCII encoded hexadecimal string identifier for the local or remote SNMPengine, length of 24 characters (including only characters 0-9 and A-F). If less than 24characters are specified, the remaining characters are automatically filled with zeros. An all 0,all F, or null value is not allowed.
Mode
5-418
snmp-server group
Sets up a new SNMP group. The no form of this command removes a specified SNMP group. Syntax snmp-server group groupname {v1 | v2c | v3 {auth | noauth | priv}} *[notify notifyview | readreadview | write writeview] no snmp-server group groupname {v1 | v2c | v3 {auth | noauth | priv}} *[notify notifyview |read readview | write writeview] Parameters Parameter groupname v1 v2c v3 auth noauth priv notifyview Description Name of the SNMP group. SNMP version 1. SNMP version 2c. SNMP version 3. Specifies packet authentication without encryption. Specifies no packet authentication. Specifies packet authentication with encryption. Specifies a notify view for the SNMP group, notifyview range is 1 to 127 alphanumericsymbolic characters, default is null OID. Specifies a read view for the SNMP group, readview range is 1 to 127 alphanumericsymbolic characters, default is every object in the OID space. writeview Specifies a write view for the SNMP group, writeview range is 1 to 127 alphanumericsymbolic characters, default is null OID. Mode Global Configuration
readview
snmp-server host
This command sets up a host to receive SNMP notifications. If no keywords are supplied, all
5-419
5-420
snmp-server location
Sets the system location string. The no form of this command removes the system location string(default). Syntax snmp-server location string no snmp-server location [string] Parameters Parameter string Description System location string, range is 0 to 255 alpha-numeric-symbolic characters.
snmp-server packetsize
Sets the maximum SNMP packet size permitted for requests and replies. The no form of this command sets the maximum SNMP packet size to the default value. Syntax snmp-server packetsize byte-count no snmp-server packetsize [byte-count] Parameters Parameter byte-count Description Maximum size of SNMP packets in bytes, range is 484 to 8192, default is 1500.
5-421
snmp-server queue-length
Sets the queue length of SNMP trap messages to be re-transmitted. The no form of this command sets the queue length to the default value. Syntax snmp-server queue-length length no snmp-server queue-length [length] Parameters Parameter length Description Number of SNMP trap messages to queue, range is 1 to 1000, default is 10.
snmp-server queue-transmit-rate
Sets the maximum allowable rate for SNMP trap message re-transmission. The no form of thiscommand sets the maximum allowable rate to the default value. Syntax snmp-server queue-transmit-rate traps-per-second no snmp-server queue-transmit-rate [traps-per-second] Parameters Parameter traps-per-second Description Maximum allowable rate for SNMP trap retransmission, range is 1 to 10,default is 4.
snmp-server trap-source
Sets the source IP address of all traps to a specified value. The no version of this command removes the source IP address designation (default).
5-422
Mode Global Configuration Guidelines Use this command to force all notifications to originate from a specified interface. Normally, anSNMP trap has the address of the interface that sent it.
snmp-server trap-timeout
Sets the timeout interval at which SNMP trap message re-transmission will be attempted. The noform of this command sets the timeout interval to the default value. Syntax snmp-server trap-timeout seconds no snmp-server trap-timeout [seconds] Parameters Parameter seconds Description Number of seconds for the interval at which SNMP trap message re-transmission isattempted, range is 1 to 1000, default is 30.
snmp-server user
5-423
snmp-server view
Creates or updates a view entry. The no form of this command removes a server view entry. Syntax snmp-server view view-name oid-tree {included | excluded}
5-424
snmp-trap-receive
When SNMP access is enabled for a router, the SVP will determine the link state of a router via polling of the MIBII table. It might be desirable to decrease the latency of this learned state by having the router send a trap to the SVP. This command configures the SVP to listen for SNMP traps. As a security mechanism, the SVP has to configured to process traps from expected routers. Unexpected traps will be dropped. When an interface state trap is received, the SVP will update the link's state in the associated DRIB. The SVP can also be configured to poll all routers configured with the route-table-poll command when a link down trap is received. Since the route-table-poll is not as reactive as peering, using this triggering event will allow the SVP to update the DRIBs more quickly. By default the SVP will not listen far traps. The no form of this command returns the system to the default state. Syntax snmp-trap-receive [udp-port <port>] [trigger-route-polling<maximum-rate>] no snmp-trap-receive [udp-port <port>] [trigger-route-polling<maximum-rate>] Parameters Parameter udp-port maximum-rate Description UDP port agent is listening on. Bounds the frequency in seconds at which polling will be done due to a link down event. Type/Range 1-255 5-360 Default 162 Not enabled
5-425
snmp-trap-source
This command is used to configure the SVP to process link up and down traps from the associated router in the topology map. The snmp-trap-receive command is required in addition to this command to listen for the traps. The By default the SVP will not process traps from a router. The no form of this command returns the system to the default state. Syntax snmp-trap-source [ip-address <ip-address>] version {1| 2c} [encrypted] community <community-string> no snmp-trap-source [ip-address <ip-address>] version {1| 2c} [encrypted] community <community-string> Parameters Parameter ip-address version encrypted community Mode Topology map router configuration Description Process traps from this ip-address. Specifies SNMP version Used by system to encrypt running configuration community string output. Specifies SNMP community string. String None 1/2c Type/Range Default Use router IP address
snrsp
If the SVA is enabled for performing analogue metric collection, it will process the RTP payload of voice call streams and determine the signal to noise ratio (SNR). When the signal to noise ratio falls below a certain level, the listener will find it difficult to understand the talker. This command specifies the SNR value to be used to for determining if a call should be marked as being degraded due to noise. If the SNR value is very low, the speech and the noise cannot be distinguished. This can occur in the following cases: The sample analyzed does not contain speech. The sample analyzed has a noise level very near the speech level.
5-426
The first case is not of concern, while the second is the purpose of performing the analysis. One way to distinguish these two cases is by considering the value of the signal level. In the first case, the level would be expected to be low around -40 dBov. In the second case, the level would be -26 dBov or higher. This command also specifies the percentage of degraded sessions to all sessions measured for determining if an alert should be generated. If the calculated percentage is greater than the configured percentage, an alert will be generated. The command replaces the existing SNR threshold and/or the settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the SNRSP alert for all time intervals and returns the SNR thresholds to their default value. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the SNRSP alert for that time interval. The no form of the command with a threshold parameter will return that parameter to its default setting.
Syntax snrsp {[snr <snr>] [slevel <slevel>] [interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } no snrsp {[snr <snr>] [slevel <slevel>] [interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter snr Description If the SNR value is less than or equal to this value, the session is marked as degraded. If the signal and noise level cannot be distinguished and the level is greater than or equal to this value, the session is labeled as degraded. set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. Type/Range 0 to 100 20 Default
slevel
-80 to 0
-40
interval1 interval2
None None
interval3 interval4
None None
5-427
set
If the percentage of sessions with noise degradation is greater than this value an alarm will be sent. If the percentage of sessions with noise degradation is less than or equal to this value the alarm will be cleared.
0-99
none
clear
0-99
none
source
Specifies a file that is read as a source of commands which are executed sequentially. Syntax source filename Parameters Parameter filename Mode Protmon Configuration Guidelines Source commands may be nested up to 5 levels. Description Name of source file.
speed
Overrides auto negotiation on the Ethernet interface to force a speed. This is only supported for nnet0 and em interfaces. The command may be needed when connecting the interface to a non-gigabit interface or when the far end interface is configured at a speed below a gigabit speed. The no form of the command returns the setting back to the default which is auto negotiation.
5-428
spf-log
Sets the number of records kept in the OSPF spf-log (which is visible using the show ip ospf spflogcommand). The no form of this command returns the value to the default (20). Syntax spf-log entries number no spf-log entries number Parameters Parameter number Description Number of entries kept in the OSPF spf-log, range is 0 to 100000, default is 20.
spf-log entries
Specifies the number of records kept in the IS-IS spf-log (which is visible using the show isis spflogcommand). The no form of this command returns the value to the default (20). Syntax
5-429
ssl-certificate-install
This command is used to install a SSL certificate. The no form of this command will override an existing certificate with a default one. Syntax ssl-certificate-install [directory {swdepot: | ftproot: | /}] no ssl-certificate-install [directory {swdepot: | ftproot: | /}] Parameters Parameter directory Description Optional parameter indicating the location of the certificate file. Default ftproot
Mode EXEC
stamp
Enables the inclusion of timestamps in the trace file (default). The no form of this command disables the inclusion of timestamps. Syntax stamp no stamp Mode
5-430
stream-capture
The stream-capture command is used to setup capturing filter for a SVA host to capture a stream of packets and associate related packets to an identified flow. The current implementation of the command is specifically for RTP streams. The RTP packets should be associated with routed interface either in one direction or both. Mixing RTP packet streams across multiple routed interfaces will decrease the usability of the collected metrics for identifying where the service degradation is occurring in the network.
Syntax stream-capture interface <if-name>router-ip <router-ip> router-interface-ip <routerinterface-ip>[direction {both | ingress | egress}] [port-range <first-port><last-port>] [message-filter {rtp}] no stream-capture interface <if-name>router-ip <router-ip> router-interface-ip <routerinterface-ip>[direction {both | ingress | egress}] [port-range <first-port><last-port>] [message-filter {rtp}]
Parameters Parameter interface router-ip router-interface-ip direction Description Required parameter, the <if-name> specifies the Ethernet interface for tapping on a specific SVA host. Required parameter which specifies the router IP address the stream is associated with. Required parameter which specifies the IP address of the router interface the stream is associated with. Optional parameter with a default value of egress. A value of ingress specifies the stream is being received by the router interface. A value of egress specifies the stream is being transmitted by the router interface. A value of both infers that both directions are being combined in a single SPAN port. NOTE: combining both directions should be avoided unless it is guaranteed not to cause over subscription or added delay. Optional parameter specifying the UDP port range used for identifying streams. The default value of the first port is 5000 and the default value of the last port is 65535. For RTP 5060 is always ignored. As noted previously the only stream currently supported is RTP streams.
port-range
message-filter
5-431
summary-address (OSPF)
Creates summary routes (aggregates) for routes that are being redistributed from other routingprotocols into OSPF. The no form of this command removes the aggregate address. Syntax summary-address [ip-address/mask-length | ip-address netmask] [not-advertise | tag tagvalue] no summary-address [ip-address/mask-length | ip-address netmask] [not-advertise | tag tagvalue] Parameters Parameter ip-address/mask-length ip-address netmask not-advertise tag-value Mode Router Configuration (OSPF) Description Summary routes IP address and prefix netmask length (in bits). Summary routes IP address and prefix netmask. Routes that are covered by the summaryaddress will not be advertised by thisrouter. Range is 0 to 4294967295.
5-432
suppress-svp-kpi-alerts
If sites are defined for an SVP, then site based alerts will be generated for the various KPIs. It is sometimes convenient to suppress the SVP based alerts that might be declared so that the site based alerts are the primary focus of trouble shooting. This suppression should only be done if all expected sessions being monitored are associated with a site. Otherwise network anomalies will not result in an alert. The no form of this command removes the alert suppression. Syntax suppress-svp-kpi-alerts no suppress-svp-kpi-alerts Mode session-thresholds
sv-config
Each of the servers deployed as part of the visibility solution requires configuration information specific to the deployment which is unknown during system installation in the factory. This command provides a mechanism for the default installation information to be changed to align with the specific deployment criteria. The passwords in this command affect the shell login only and do not interact with the user accounts established via CLI. The sva-analogue SV type is used to enable measurement of analogue metrics from received
5-433
Parameters Parameter root-password admin-password sv-type deployment-type Mode User EXEC Description Change the shell root password. Change the shell admin password. Indicate the role the service visibility type of the node. Indicate the type of deployment.
svm-synchronization peer-ip-address
When more than one SVM monitors the same SVP(s), it is important that they are configured to maintain the same configuration data that is applied through the GUI. If this is not done, one SVM will arbitrarily over ride the configuration of the other. Also, users connected one SVM will have a different view than users connected to the other SVM. This command is used in conjunction with the svm-synchronization primary command to configure peering between the SVMs to maintain consistency. Each SVM must be configured with the IP address of the other SVM(s) monitoring the SVPs. The no form of this command removes a peer based on the ip address specified. Syntax svm-synchronization peer-ip-address <ip-address> no svm-synchronization peer-ip-address <ip-address>
5-434
peer-ip-address
svm-synchronization primary
This command is used in conjunction with the svm-synchronization peer-ip-address command to configure peering between the SVMs to maintain consistency of the configuration applied via the GUI. Each SVM must be configured with the IP address of the other SVM(s) monitoring the SVPs. This command instructs the SVM to assume the primary role. This triggers the sending of a request to the current primary SVM to become the new primary. After acknowledgement, the roles are changed on both SVMs. The previous primary will become secondary and automatically remove the primary configuration mode. The no form of this command changes the primary to secondary. The SVM will notify its peers regarding this state change. Syntax svm-synchronization primary no svm-synchronization primary Mode Global configuration
switch network
This command switches operations from public network to private network. This command is only valid on the SVP. Syntax switch network Mode EXEC
synchronization
5-435
table-map (BGP)
Sets route metric, tag information and other attributes in the IP routing table for learned routes,rather than using the default values. The no form of this command disables the use of the routemapfor updating the IP routing table. Syntax table-map route-map-name no table-map [route-map-name] Parameters Parameter route-map-name Description Route map that specifies route metric and tag information for BGP-learnedroutes to be added to the IP routing table.
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Unicast VRF) Address Family Configuration (IPv6 Multicast) Address Family Configuration (VPNv4 Unicast)
5-436
table-map (OSPF)
Sets route metric, tag information, and other attributes in the IP routing table for learned routesusing the the specified route map, rather than the default values. The no form of this commanddisables the use of the route-map for updating the IP routing table. Syntax table-map route-map-name no table-map [route-map-name] Parameters Parameter route-map-name Description Route map that specifies route metric and tag information for BGP-learnedroutes to be added to the IP routing table.
tacacs-server host
Sets a TACACS+ server host to be used by the RCP. The no form of this command removes aTACACS+ server host. Syntax tacacs-server host {host | ip-address} *[key [encryption-type] key-value | port port-value | single-connection | timeout seconds] no tacacs-server host {host | ip-address} *[key [encryption-type] key-value | port port-value |single-connection | timeout seconds] Parameters Parameter host ip-address Description Name of TACACS+ server host. IP address of TACACS+ server host.
5-437
encryption-type
Specifies whether the key that follows is encrypted. A value of 0 (default)indicates the following key is not encrypted, and a value of 7 indicates the following key isencrypted. Authentication key value, range is 1 to 8 alpha-numeric-symbolic characters(cannot begin with a # character and spaces are not allowed), default is the value set by thetacacs-server key command. TACACS+ server host port number, range is 1 to 65535, default is 49. Specifies that a single connection be maintained for TACACS+ serverhost confirmation. Number of seconds to wait for the TACACS+ server host to respond before resendinga TACACS+ request, range is 1 to 1000, default is the value set by the tacacsservertimeout command.
key-value
port-value single-connection
seconds
tacacs-server key
Sets the authentication key for all TACACS+ requests and responses. The no form of this command disables the authentication key. Syntax tacacs-server key [encryption-type] key-value no tacacs-server key [[encryption-type] key-value] Parameters Parameter encryption-type Description Specifies whether the key that follows is encrypted. A value of 0 (default)indicates the following key is not encrypted, and a value of 7 indicates the following key isencrypted.
5-438
key-value
Authentication key value, range is 1 to 8 alpha-numeric-symbolic characters(cannot begin with a # character and spaces are not allowed).
tacacs-server timeout
Sets the duration of time to wait for a TACACS+ server host to respond. The no form of this command sets the default. Syntax tacacs-server timeout seconds no tacacs-server timeout [seconds] Parameters Parameter seconds Description Number of seconds to wait for a TACACS+ server host to respond, range is 1 to1000, default is 5.
telnet
Opens a Telnet connection with a remote host. Syntax telnet {host | ip-address} *[port | 8bit | source-interface interface-name] Parameters Parameter host ip-address Description Name of the destination host. IP address of the destination host.
5-439
TCP port number of the destination host, range is 1 to 65535, default is 23. Use an 8-bit data path. Set the Telnet connection source address to a specified interface value. {admin 0 | loopback loopback-number | nnet rcp-number | port-chanchannelnumber[.subinterface] | pos-chan channelnumber | tunnel tunnel-number}.
terminal exec-timeout
Sets the EXEC command line interpreter timeout period for the current session (specifying 0 minutes and 0 seconds disables the timeout function). The no form of this command sets theEXEC command line interpreter timeout period for the current session to the system default valueset by the exec-timeout command (default). Syntax terminal exec-timeout minutes [seconds] terminal no exec-timeout [minutes [seconds]] Parameters Parameter minutes seconds Description Number of minutes, range is 0 to 65535. Additional number of seconds, range is 0 to 65535, default is 0.
terminal history
Enables the command line history feature for the current session (default). Alternatively, withthe size keyword specified, this command sets the number of lines in the history buffer for thecurrent session. The terminal no history form of this command disables the command line historyfeature. The terminal no history size form of this command sets the size of the history buffer tothe default value.
5-440
terminal length
Sets the number of display lines per screen for the current session. The no form of this commandsets the number of display lines per screen to the system default value set by the lengthcommand (default). Syntax terminal length screen-length terminal no length [screen-length] Parameters Parameter screen-length Description Number of lines displayed on the terminal, range is 0 to 512. A value of 0disables pausing between full screens of output.
Mode User EXEC Guidelines This command is used to set the session page size for paged output applications.
terminal monitor
Enables the output of debug and error messages for the current session. The no form of this command disables the output of debug and error messages (default).
5-441
terminal width
Sets the number of characters per display line for the current session. The no form of this command sets the number of characters per display line to the system default value set by thewidth command (default). Syntax terminal width characters terminal no width [characters] Parameters Parameter characters Description Width (in characters) of the text displayed on the terminal, range is 0 to 512.
timers bgp
Sets the values for BGP timers. The no form of this command resets the BGP timers to their default values. Syntax timers bgp keepalive-timer hold-timer
5-442
hold-timer
Mode Router Configuration (BGP) Address Family Configuration (IPv4 Unicast) Guidelines The keepalive-timer value specified must be less than the hold-timer value specified.
timers copsrm
This command specifies the global COPS-RM keep alive and dead timer values. A keep alive timer value of 0 turns off the sending of keep alive messages. The no form of this command regardless of parameter value, returns the settings to their default value. Syntax timers copsrm <tx-keep-alive-interval><rx-dead-interval> no timers copsrm <tx-keep-alive-interval><rx-dead-interval> Parameters Parameter tx-keep-aliveinterval rx-dead-interval Description Time in seconds between sending of keep alive messages. Time lapse between messages before peer is assumed dead. Type/Range 0-65535 seconds 0-65535 seconds 60 180 Default
Mode
5-443
timers spf
Sets the routers SPF timers for OSPF routing protocol. The no form of this command sets thetimers to their default values. Syntax timers spf spf-delay spf-holdtime no timers spf [spf-delay spf-holdtime] Parameters Parameter spf-delay Description Amount of time in seconds between when OSPF receives a topology change andwhen it starts a shortest path first calculation, range is 0 to 65535, default is 5. Minimum time, in seconds, between two consecutive SPF calculations, range is0 to 65535, default is 10.
spf-holdtime
topology-link
Manually connects interfaces of two different routers. A user is able to use the command when there is no routing protocol connecting two routers and the topology manager cannot discover connectivity between the routers. The connection is bidirectional in such case. Syntax topology-link host-address ip-address interface-name interface-name-string to hostaddress ip-address interface-name interface-name-string no topology-link host-address ip-address interface-name interface-name-string to hostaddress ip-address interface-name interface-name-string Parameter ip-address Description IP address, in the format of a.b.c.d, which represents the node-id of a node in the network.
5-444
interface-name-string
Mode Topology-Map Configuration Guidelines The two interfaces, between which the connection is being established, shall have the same interface type. Otherwise the connectivity cannot be established. Configuration on the loopback interface has no effect.
topology-map
To configure SVP topology related information, use the topology-map command in global configuration mode. This command puts CLI in topology-map mode which enables topology map configuration commands to be entered. Syntax topology-map<map-name> no topology-map<map-name> Parameters Parameter map-name Description name of the map that identifies the topology map Type/Range String Default None
topology-unlink
Manually disconnects interfaces of two different routers. If routing protocol is not running between two routers, a user is able to manually disconnect interfaces of two different routers. The connection is bidirectional in such case. Syntax topology-unlink host-address ip-address interface-name interface-name-string to hostaddress ip-address interface-name interface-name-string no topology-unlink host-address ip-address interface-name interface-name-string to hostaddress ip-address interface-name interface-name-string
5-445
Parameter ip-address
Description IP address, in the format of a.b.c.d, which represents the node-id of a node in the network. The name of the link or interface in a string format.
interface-name-string
traceoptions
Enters into the Traceoptions Configuration Mode to configure trace options for the specified tracefile. The no form of this command removes all trace options for the specified trace file, or for alltrace files if no trace file is specified. Syntax traceoptions trace-filename no traceoptions [trace-filename] Parameters Parameter trace-filename Mode Global Configuration Guidelines When attempting to remove all trace options for all trace files, a confirmation message will bedisplayed. Type y to continue or n to cancel this command. Description Filename of the trace file.
traceroute (privileged)
Displays the actual IP routes that a packet takes through the network.
5-446
If this command is issued without options, the user is prompted with the following fields: Parameter Target IP address Description IP address of the destination host.
5-447
Source address or interface Numeric display [n] Timeout in seconds [3] Probe count [3] Minimum Time to Live [1] Maximum Time to Live [30] Port Number [33434]
Source name or address, or interface-name for outgoingpackets. Only numeric addresses are displayed, default is no. Number of seconds to wait for a response to a probe, range is 2 to86399, default is 3. Number of probes per hop, range is 1 to 255, default is 3. Minimum time for time-to-live value, range is 1 to 30, default is 1. Maximum time for time-to-live value, range is 1 to 30, default is30. For UDP and TCP, the base port number used in probes, range is 1 to65535, default is 33434. Specify nodes that must be used in the route. Up to 8 IP addresses separated by spaces. Size of the trace datagram in bytes, range is 40 to 32768, default isminimum required (40 bytes plus bytes needed for ip options). Type of service, range is 0 to 255, default is 0.
Mode Privileged EXEC Guidelines If a datagram size is specified and it is insufficient to support the additional number of bytes required for the loose source route specified: a) the command line form of the command will be denied with an error message; b) the prompted form of the command will display an error message after the datagram size entry and allow the user to re-enter the datagram size.
traceroute (user)
Displays the actual IP routes that a packet takes through the network. Syntax traceroute {host | ip-address} Parameters
5-448
tsr
Tunnel Success Ratio (TSR) is a percentage of tunnel establishment attempts that are successful. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the TSR alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the TSR alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS based on the Tunnel Success Ratio. The command is validated to make sure the set threshold is less than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax tsr {[interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } no tsr {[interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } Parameters Parameter interval1 interval2 interval3 interval4 set clear Description set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. Value of ratio is less than this value, alert will set. Value of ratio is greater than or equal to this value, alert will clear. 00 to 100 where 00 implies off. 00 to 100 Type/Range Default None None None None 00 00
5-449
tunnel
Enables tunnel debug messages to be placed in the trace file. The no form of this command disables tunnel debug messages from being placed in the trace file (default). Syntax tunnel no tunnel Mode Traceoptions Configuration
tunnel destination
Sets the destination for a tunnel interface. The no form of this command removes the destinationfor the tunnel interface. Syntax tunnel destination ip-address no tunnel destination [ip-address] Parameters Parameter ip-address Mode Interface Configuration (Tunnel) Description IP address of the host destination.
5-450
tunnel source
Sets the source address of an IP tunnel to the indicated address or the address configured on aparticular interface. This command is supported for GRE, IPIP and EON tunnels only. Syntax tunnel source {ip-address | interface-name} no tunnel source {ip-address | interface-name} Parameters Parameter ip-address interface-name Description IP address to be used for source address of an IP tunnel. Interface to be used as source address of an IP tunnel.
uersp
If the SVA is enabled for performing analogue metric collection, it will process the RTP payload of voice call streams and determine the echo annoyance rating. The rating can be any of the following: None Detected Side Tone Acceptable Unacceptable When a call is labeled as having unacceptable echo, it is marked as being degraded. This command specifies the percentage of degraded sessions to all sessions measured for determining if an alert should be generated. If the calculated percentage is greater than the configured percentage, an alert will be generated. The command replaces the existing UERSP settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the UERSP alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the UERSP alert for that time interval.
5-451
clear
0-99
none
username
This command is used to add or modify a user on the SVP and SVM. The no form will remove a user from the system. Syntax username <username>[privilege <level>] [password [0|7]<password-string> [xml | gui]]
5-452
validate
Checks the route-map that is currently being modified for errors in the use of the route-map. Syntax validate Mode IP Policy-List Configuration Route-Map Configuration Route-Map Assign Guidelines This command does the same thing as validate route-map, but only for the route-map being modified.
validate policy-list
Checks the specified policy-list (or all policy-lists if none is specified) for correctness and references to missing access-lists or other objects.
5-453
validate policy
Checks the specified protocol (or all protocols if none is specified) for errors in the use of routemapsand access-lists. Syntax validate policy [bgp | isis [isis-tag] | ospf [ospf-id]] Parameters Parameter bgp isis [isis-tag] Description Checks route-maps and access-lists used in BGP. Checks route-maps and access-lists used in the IS-IS processes specified byisis-tag, or all IS-IS processes if no isis-tag is entered. Checks route-maps and access-lists used in the OSPF process specifiedby instance-id, or all OSPF processes if no instance-id is entered.
ospf [instance-id]
Mode Privileged EXEC Guidelines This command shows where undefined access-lists or route-maps are specified in the configuration. This command also shows where route-maps use match and set conditions thatare not consistent with where the route-maps are being used (e.g., match community in OSPFdefault-originate route-map).
5-454
validate route-map
Checks the specified route-map (or all route-maps if none is specified) for errors in the use of theroute-map. Syntax validate route-map [route-map-name] Parameters Parameter route-map-name Mode Privileged EXEC Description Route map to be validated.
pdd
The Post Dial Delay (PDD) threshold is the percentage of call sessions with a PDD that exceeds the std-dly or non-std-dly configured. The delays are specified in milliseconds. The system determines which delay to use based on the destination ID of the session. If the prefix of the destination ID is defined in the non-standard list (see session-non-std-dest command), the non-std-dly is used. Otherwise, the std-dly is used. If the percentage of sessions with excessive PDD is greater than or equal to the defined threshold, the APDD alert is generated. The command replaces the existing delay values and/or the settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the APDD alert for all time intervals and returns the delay values to their default. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the APDD alert for that time interval. The no form of the command with the std-dly or non-std-dly value will return the setting to its default value. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS. The set threshold must be greater than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax pdd {[std-dly std-dly>] [non-std-dly non-std-dly>] [interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } no pdd {[std-dly std-dly>] [non-std-dly non-std-dly>] [interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] }
5-455
non-std-dly
0-65535
5000 ms
interval1 interval2
None None
clear
0-99
none
vdd
The Video Disconnect Delay (VDD) threshold is the percentage of video sessions with a VDD that exceeds the std-dly or non-std-dly configured. The delays are specified in milliseconds. The system determines which delay to use based on the destination ID of the session. If the prefix of the destination ID is defined in the non-standard list (see session-non-std-dest
5-456
non-std-dly
0-65535
5000 ms
interval1 interval2
None None
interval3 interval4
None None
5-457
set
If the percentage of sessions with an excessive delay is greater than this value an alarm will be sent. If the percentage of sessions with an excessive delay is less than or equal to this value the alarm will be cleared.
0-99
none
clear
0-99
none
vpdd
The Video Post Dial Delay (PDD) threshold is the percentage of video sessions with a PDD that exceeds the std-dly or non-std-dly configured. The delays are specified in milliseconds. The system determines which delay to use based on the destination ID of the session. If the prefix of the destination ID is defined in the non-standard list (see session-non-std-dest command), the non-std-dly is used. Otherwise, the std-dly is used. If the percentage of sessions with excessive PDD is greater than or equal to the defined threshold, the Average Video Post Dial Delay ( AVPDD) alert is generated. The command replaces the existing delay values and/or the settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the AVPDD alert for all time intervals and returns the delay values to their default. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the AVPDD alert for that time interval. The no form of the command with the std-dly or non-std-dly value will return the setting to its default value. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS. The set threshold must be greater than or equal to the clear threshold. Syntax vpdd {[std-dly std-dly>] [non-std-dly non-std-dly>] [interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } no vpdd {[std-dly std-dly>] [non-std-dly non-std-dly>] [interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] }
5-458
Parameters Parameter std-dly Description PDD delay in ms for sessions with default destinations; i.e. not a non-standard prefix. PDD delay in ms for sessions with a nonstandard destination; i.e. a non-standard prefix. set/clear thresholds for first interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for second interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for third interval of the day. set/clear thresholds for fourth interval of the day. If the percentage of sessions with an excessive delay is greater than this value an alarm will be sent. If the percentage of sessions with an excessive delay is less than or equal to this value the alarm will be cleared. 0-99 Type/Range 0-65535 Default 5000 ms
non-std-dly
0-65535
5000 ms
interval1 interval2
None None
clear
0-99
none
vrrp-mib
This command enables the SVP to gather information from the router's VRRP MIB. VRRP is deployed at the access point to a network to provide redundancy to hosts connected via a layer 2 network. By enabling this feature for the routers involved in the VRRP scheme, the SVP can
5-459
vsr
Video Success Ratio (VSR) is an aggregate percentage of video session attempts that are successful. The command replaces the existing settings for the intervals specified. The no form of the command with no arguments disables the VSR alert for all time intervals. The no form of the command with a single interval, regardless of set/clear threshold value, will disable the VSR alert for that time interval. This command enables generation of alerts to the SVM and traps to the NMS based on the Video Success Ratio. The set threshold must be less than or equal to the clear threshold per time interval. Syntax vsr {[interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set <set> clear <clear>] [interval4set <set> clear <clear>] } no vsr {[interval1set <set> clear <clear>] [interval2set <set> clear <clear>] [interval3set
5-460
wall
Sends an asynchronous user message to all users. Syntax wall [partition {all | {admin | hostname | partition-number}}] Parameters Parameter partition Description Send to a specified partition, set of partitions, or all partitions. If omitted, send tothe current partition. Hostname of a router partition, range is 1 to 63 alphanumeric or hyphen characters(the first or last character cannot be a hyphen). Router partition number, range is 0 to 5.
hostname
5-461
whatis
Displays output from a keyword search in the man-page database. Syntax whatis keyword Parameters Parameter keyword Description Text string to search in the man-page database.
Mode All command modes Guidelines The man-page database only contains the names of the CLI commands.
width
Sets the number of characters per display line. The no form of this command sets the number ofcharacters per display line to automatically be determined using the negotiated login window size(default). Syntax width characters no width [characters] Parameters Parameter characters Description Width (in characters) of the text displayed on the terminal, range is 0 to 512.
world-readable
NetSocket, Inc. - Proprietary and Confidential 5-462
5-463